* gdb.texinfo (Environment): Document that `path' does not change
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
1 \input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
2 @c Copyright 1988-2001
3 @c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
4 @c
5 @c %**start of header
6 @c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
7 @c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
8 @setfilename gdb.info
9 @c
10 @include gdb-cfg.texi
11 @c
12 @settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
13 @setchapternewpage odd
14 @c %**end of header
15
16 @iftex
17 @c @smallbook
18 @c @cropmarks
19 @end iftex
20
21 @finalout
22 @syncodeindex ky cp
23
24 @c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
25 @c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
26 @syncodeindex vr cp
27 @syncodeindex fn cp
28
29 @c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
30 @set EDITION Eighth
31
32 @c !!set GDB manual's revision date
33 @set DATE March 2000
34
35 @c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 3.12 OR LATER.
36
37 @c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
38 @c manuals to an info tree.
39 @dircategory Programming & development tools.
40 @direntry
41 * Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
42 @end direntry
43
44 @ifinfo
45 This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
46
47
48 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
49 of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
50 for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
51
52 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
53
54 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
55 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
56 are preserved on all copies.
57
58 @ignore
59 Permission is granted to process this file through TeX and print the
60 results, provided the printed document carries copying permission
61 notice identical to this one except for the removal of this paragraph
62 (this paragraph not being relevant to the printed manual).
63
64 @end ignore
65 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
66 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
67 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
68 permission notice identical to this one.
69
70 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
71 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
72 @end ifinfo
73
74 @titlepage
75 @title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
76 @subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
77 @sp 1
78 @subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
79 @subtitle @value{DATE}
80 @author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
81 @page
82 @tex
83 {\parskip=0pt
84 \hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
85 \hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
86 \hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
87 }
88 @end tex
89
90 @vskip 0pt plus 1filll
91 Copyright @copyright{} 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
92 @sp 2
93 Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
94 59 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
95 Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
96 ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
97
98 Permission is granted to make and distribute verbatim copies of
99 this manual provided the copyright notice and this permission notice
100 are preserved on all copies.
101
102 Permission is granted to copy and distribute modified versions of this
103 manual under the conditions for verbatim copying, provided also that the
104 entire resulting derived work is distributed under the terms of a
105 permission notice identical to this one.
106
107 Permission is granted to copy and distribute translations of this manual
108 into another language, under the above conditions for modified versions.
109 @end titlepage
110 @page
111
112 @ifinfo
113 @node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
114
115 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
116
117 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
118
119 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
120 @value{GDBVN}.
121
122 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
123
124 @menu
125 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
126 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
127
128 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
129 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
130 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
131 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
132 * Stack:: Examining the stack
133 * Source:: Examining source files
134 * Data:: Examining data
135
136 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
137
138 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
139 * Altering:: Altering execution
140 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
141 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
142 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
143 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
144 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
145 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
147 * GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
148
149 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
155 * Index:: Index
156 @end menu
157
158 @end ifinfo
159
160 @c the replication sucks, but this avoids a texinfo 3.12 lameness
161
162 @ifhtml
163 @node Top
164
165 @top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
166
167 This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
168
169 This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
170 @value{GDBVN}.
171
172 Copyright (C) 1988-2000 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
173
174 @menu
175 * Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
176 * Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
177
178 * Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
179 * Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
180 * Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
181 * Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
182 * Stack:: Examining the stack
183 * Source:: Examining source files
184 * Data:: Examining data
185
186 * Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
187
188 * Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
189 * Altering:: Altering execution
190 * GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
191 * Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
192 * Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
193 * Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
194 * Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
195 * Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
196 * Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
197
198 * GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
199 * Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
200
201 * Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
202 * Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
203 * Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
204 * Index:: Index
205 @end menu
206
207 @end ifhtml
208
209 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
210 @iftex
211 @contents
212 @end iftex
213
214 @node Summary
215 @unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
216
217 The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
218 going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
219 program was doing at the moment it crashed.
220
221 @value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
222 these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
223
224 @itemize @bullet
225 @item
226 Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
227
228 @item
229 Make your program stop on specified conditions.
230
231 @item
232 Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
233
234 @item
235 Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
236 effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
237 @end itemize
238
239 You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
240 For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
241 For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
242
243 @cindex Chill
244 @cindex Modula-2
245 Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
246 see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
247
248 @cindex Pascal
249 Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
250 nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
251 entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
252 syntax.
253
254 @cindex Fortran
255 @value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
256 it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
257 underscore.
258
259 @menu
260 * Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
261 * Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
262 @end menu
263
264 @node Free Software
265 @unnumberedsec Free software
266
267 @value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
268 General Public License
269 (GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
270 program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
271 freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
272 the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
273 Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
274 Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
275
276 Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
277 you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
278 from anyone else.
279
280 @node Contributors
281 @unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
282
283 Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
284 other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
285 development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
286 of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
287 to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
288 file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
289 blow-by-blow account.
290
291 Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
292
293 @quotation
294 @emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
295 or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
296 omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
297 @end quotation
298
299 So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
300 particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
301 releases:
302 Andrew Cagney (release 5.0);
303 Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
304 Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
305 Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
306 Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
307 Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
308 John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
309 Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
310 and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
311
312 Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
313 Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
314
315 Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C++ support in
316 @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
317 Bothner. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C++ demangler. Early work on
318 C++ was by Peter TerMaat (who also did much general update work leading
319 to release 3.0).
320
321 @value{GDBN} 4 uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
322 object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
323 Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
324
325 David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
326 the original support for encapsulated COFF.
327
328 Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
329
330 Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
331 Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
332 support.
333 Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
334 Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
335 Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
336 David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
337 Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
338 Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
339 Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
340 Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
341 Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
342 Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
343 Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
344 Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
345 Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
346 Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
347 Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
348
349 Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
350
351 Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
352 libraries.
353
354 Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
355 about several machine instruction sets.
356
357 Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
358 remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
359 contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
360 and RDI targets, respectively.
361
362 Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
363 command-line editing and command history.
364
365 Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
366 Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
367
368 Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
369 He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C++ overloaded
370 symbols.
371
372 Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
373 Super-H processors.
374
375 NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
376
377 Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
378
379 Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
380
381 Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
382
383 Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
384
385 Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
386 watchpoints.
387
388 Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
389
390 Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
391
392 Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
393 nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
394
395 The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
396 support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
397 (narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC++
398 compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
399 John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
400 Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
401 information in this manual.
402
403 Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
404 development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
405 fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
406 Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
407 Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
408 Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
409 Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
410 addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
411 JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
412 Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
413 Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
414 Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
415 Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
416 Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
417 Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
418
419
420 @node Sample Session
421 @chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
422
423 You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
424 However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
425 debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
426
427 @iftex
428 In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
429 to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
430 @end iftex
431
432 @c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
433 @c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
434
435 One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
436 processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
437 quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
438 definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
439 session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
440 then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
441 same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
442 @code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
443 procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
444
445 @smallexample
446 $ @b{cd gnu/m4}
447 $ @b{./m4}
448 @b{define(foo,0000)}
449
450 @b{foo}
451 0000
452 @b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
453
454 @b{bar}
455 0000
456 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
457
458 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
459 @b{baz}
460 @b{C-d}
461 m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
462 @end smallexample
463
464 @noindent
465 Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
466
467 @smallexample
468 $ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
469 @c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
470 @c FIXME... format to come out better.
471 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
472 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
473 the conditions.
474 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
475 for details.
476
477 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
478 (@value{GDBP})
479 @end smallexample
480
481 @noindent
482 @value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
483 rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
484 We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
485 that examples fit in this manual.
486
487 @smallexample
488 (@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
489 @end smallexample
490
491 @noindent
492 We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
493 Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
494 @code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
495 @code{break} command.
496
497 @smallexample
498 (@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
499 Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
500 @end smallexample
501
502 @noindent
503 Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
504 control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
505 subroutine, the program runs as usual:
506
507 @smallexample
508 (@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
509 Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
510 @b{define(foo,0000)}
511
512 @b{foo}
513 0000
514 @end smallexample
515
516 @noindent
517 To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
518 suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
519 context where it stops.
520
521 @smallexample
522 @b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
523
524 Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
525 at builtin.c:879
526 879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
527 @end smallexample
528
529 @noindent
530 Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
531 the next line of the current function.
532
533 @smallexample
534 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
535 882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
536 : nil,
537 @end smallexample
538
539 @noindent
540 @code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
541 by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
542 @code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
543 subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
544
545 @smallexample
546 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
547 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
548 at input.c:530
549 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
550 @end smallexample
551
552 @noindent
553 The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
554 suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
555 shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
556 command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
557 in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
558 stack frame for each active subroutine.
559
560 @smallexample
561 (@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
562 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
563 at input.c:530
564 #1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
565 at builtin.c:882
566 #2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
567 #3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
568 at macro.c:71
569 #4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
570 #5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
571 @end smallexample
572
573 @noindent
574 We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
575 times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
576 falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
577
578 @smallexample
579 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
580 0x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
581 (@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
582 0x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
583 def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
584 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
585 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
586 : xstrdup(rq);
587 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
588 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
589 @end smallexample
590
591 @noindent
592 The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
593 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
594 and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
595 (@code{print}) to see their values.
596
597 @smallexample
598 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
599 $1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
600 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
601 $2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
602 @end smallexample
603
604 @noindent
605 @code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
606 To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
607 surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
608
609 @smallexample
610 (@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
611 533 xfree(rquote);
612 534
613 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
614 : xstrdup (lq);
615 536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
616 : xstrdup (rq);
617 537
618 538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
619 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
620 540 @}
621 541
622 542 void
623 @end smallexample
624
625 @noindent
626 Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
627 @code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
628
629 @smallexample
630 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
631 539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
632 (@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
633 540 @}
634 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
635 $3 = 9
636 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
637 $4 = 7
638 @end smallexample
639
640 @noindent
641 That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
642 @code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
643 @code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
644 the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
645 any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
646 assignments.
647
648 @smallexample
649 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
650 $5 = 7
651 (@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
652 $6 = 9
653 @end smallexample
654
655 @noindent
656 Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
657 @code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
658 executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
659 example that caused trouble initially:
660
661 @smallexample
662 (@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
663 Continuing.
664
665 @b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
666
667 baz
668 0000
669 @end smallexample
670
671 @noindent
672 Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
673 problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
674 lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
675
676 @smallexample
677 @b{C-d}
678 Program exited normally.
679 @end smallexample
680
681 @noindent
682 The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
683 indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
684 session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
685
686 @smallexample
687 (@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
688 @end smallexample
689
690 @node Invocation
691 @chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
692
693 This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
694 The essentials are:
695 @itemize @bullet
696 @item
697 type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
698 @item
699 type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
700 @end itemize
701
702 @menu
703 * Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
704 * Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
705 * Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
706 @end menu
707
708 @node Invoking GDB
709 @section Invoking @value{GDBN}
710
711 Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
712 @value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
713
714 You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
715 to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
716
717 The command-line options described here are designed
718 to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
719 options may effectively be unavailable.
720
721 The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
722 specifying an executable program:
723
724 @example
725 @value{GDBP} @var{program}
726 @end example
727
728 @noindent
729 You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
730 specified:
731
732 @example
733 @value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
734 @end example
735
736 You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
737 to debug a running process:
738
739 @example
740 @value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
741 @end example
742
743 @noindent
744 would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
745 named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
746
747 Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
748 complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
749 debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
750 ``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
751 will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
752
753 You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
754 @value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
755
756 @smallexample
757 @value{GDBP} -silent
758 @end smallexample
759
760 @noindent
761 You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
762 options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
763
764 @noindent
765 Type
766
767 @example
768 @value{GDBP} -help
769 @end example
770
771 @noindent
772 to display all available options and briefly describe their use
773 (@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
774
775 All options and command line arguments you give are processed
776 in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
777 @samp{-x} option is used.
778
779
780 @menu
781 * File Options:: Choosing files
782 * Mode Options:: Choosing modes
783 @end menu
784
785 @node File Options
786 @subsection Choosing files
787
788 When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
789 specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
790 the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
791 @samp{-c} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the first argument
792 that does not have an associated option flag as equivalent to the
793 @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the second argument
794 that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as equivalent to
795 the @samp{-c} option followed by that argument.)
796
797 If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
798 such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
799 argument and ignore it.
800
801 Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
802 following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
803 them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
804 (If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
805 than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
806
807 @c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
808 @c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
809 @c it.
810
811 @table @code
812 @item -symbols @var{file}
813 @itemx -s @var{file}
814 @cindex @code{--symbols}
815 @cindex @code{-s}
816 Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
817
818 @item -exec @var{file}
819 @itemx -e @var{file}
820 @cindex @code{--exec}
821 @cindex @code{-e}
822 Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
823 and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
824
825 @item -se @var{file}
826 @cindex @code{--se}
827 Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
828 file.
829
830 @item -core @var{file}
831 @itemx -c @var{file}
832 @cindex @code{--core}
833 @cindex @code{-c}
834 Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
835
836 @item -c @var{number}
837 Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command
838 (unless there is a file in core-dump format named @var{number}, in which
839 case @samp{-c} specifies that file as a core dump to read).
840
841 @item -command @var{file}
842 @itemx -x @var{file}
843 @cindex @code{--command}
844 @cindex @code{-x}
845 Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
846 Files,, Command files}.
847
848 @item -directory @var{directory}
849 @itemx -d @var{directory}
850 @cindex @code{--directory}
851 @cindex @code{-d}
852 Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
853
854 @item -m
855 @itemx -mapped
856 @cindex @code{--mapped}
857 @cindex @code{-m}
858 @emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
859 supported on all systems.}@*
860 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
861 system call, you can use this option
862 to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
863 program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
864 called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
865 Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
866 and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
867 the symbol table from the executable program.
868
869 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
870 is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
871 table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
872
873 @item -r
874 @itemx -readnow
875 @cindex @code{--readnow}
876 @cindex @code{-r}
877 Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
878 the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
879 This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
880
881 @end table
882
883 You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
884 order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
885 information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
886 on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
887 but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
888
889 @example
890 gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
891 @end example
892
893 @node Mode Options
894 @subsection Choosing modes
895
896 You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
897 batch mode or quiet mode.
898
899 @table @code
900 @item -nx
901 @itemx -n
902 @cindex @code{--nx}
903 @cindex @code{-n}
904 Do not execute commands found in any initialization files (normally
905 called @file{.gdbinit}, or @file{gdb.ini} on PCs). Normally,
906 @value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
907 options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
908 files}.
909
910 @item -quiet
911 @itemx -silent
912 @itemx -q
913 @cindex @code{--quiet}
914 @cindex @code{--silent}
915 @cindex @code{-q}
916 ``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
917 messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
918
919 @item -batch
920 @cindex @code{--batch}
921 Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
922 command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
923 initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
924 nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
925 in the command files.
926
927 Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
928 example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
929 make this more useful, the message
930
931 @example
932 Program exited normally.
933 @end example
934
935 @noindent
936 (which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
937 @value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
938 mode.
939
940 @item -nowindows
941 @itemx -nw
942 @cindex @code{--nowindows}
943 @cindex @code{-nw}
944 ``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
945 (GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
946 interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
947
948 @item -windows
949 @itemx -w
950 @cindex @code{--windows}
951 @cindex @code{-w}
952 If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
953 used if possible.
954
955 @item -cd @var{directory}
956 @cindex @code{--cd}
957 Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
958 instead of the current directory.
959
960 @item -fullname
961 @itemx -f
962 @cindex @code{--fullname}
963 @cindex @code{-f}
964 @sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
965 subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
966 number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
967 displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
968 recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
969 the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
970 and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
971 @samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
972 frame.
973
974 @item -epoch
975 @cindex @code{--epoch}
976 The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
977 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
978 routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
979 separate window.
980
981 @item -annotate @var{level}
982 @cindex @code{--annotate}
983 This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
984 effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
985 (@pxref{Annotations}).
986 Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
987 together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
988 types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
989 @value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
990 maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
991
992 @item -async
993 @cindex @code{--async}
994 Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
995 @value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
996 special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
997 commands in parallel with the debugged process being
998 run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
999 MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1000 suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1001 control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
1002 (@emph{Note:} as of version 5.0, the target side of the asynchronous
1003 operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1004 yet.)
1005 @c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1006 @c should be removed.
1007
1008 When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1009 uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1010 @samp{-noasync} option.
1011
1012 @item -noasync
1013 @cindex @code{--noasync}
1014 Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1015
1016 @item -baud @var{bps}
1017 @itemx -b @var{bps}
1018 @cindex @code{--baud}
1019 @cindex @code{-b}
1020 Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1021 interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
1022
1023 @item -tty @var{device}
1024 @itemx -t @var{device}
1025 @cindex @code{--tty}
1026 @cindex @code{-t}
1027 Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1028 @c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
1029
1030 @c resolve the situation of these eventually
1031 @c @item -tui
1032 @c @cindex @code{--tui}
1033 @c Use a Terminal User Interface. For information, use your Web browser to
1034 @c read the file @file{TUI.html}, which is usually installed in the
1035 @c directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX systems. Do not use
1036 @c this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs (see @pxref{Emacs, ,Using
1037 @c @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
1038
1039 @c @item -xdb
1040 @c @cindex @code{--xdb}
1041 @c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1042 @c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1043 @c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1044 @c systems.
1045
1046 @item -interpreter @var{interp}
1047 @cindex @code{--interpreter}
1048 Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1049 program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
1050 communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end. For example,
1051 @samp{--interpreter=mi} causes @value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdbmi
1052 interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The @sc{gdb/mi} Interface}).
1053
1054 @item -write
1055 @cindex @code{--write}
1056 Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1057 is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1058 (@pxref{Patching}).
1059
1060 @item -statistics
1061 @cindex @code{--statistics}
1062 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1063 memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1064
1065 @item -version
1066 @cindex @code{--version}
1067 This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1068 no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1069
1070 @end table
1071
1072 @node Quitting GDB
1073 @section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1074 @cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1075 @cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1076
1077 @table @code
1078 @kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1079 @kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
1080 @item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1081 @itemx q
1082 To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1083 @code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1084 do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1085 otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1086 error code.
1087 @end table
1088
1089 @cindex interrupt
1090 An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1091 terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1092 returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1093 character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1094 until a time when it is safe.
1095
1096 If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1097 device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1098 (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
1099
1100 @node Shell Commands
1101 @section Shell commands
1102
1103 If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1104 debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1105 just use the @code{shell} command.
1106
1107 @table @code
1108 @kindex shell
1109 @cindex shell escape
1110 @item shell @var{command string}
1111 Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
1112 If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
1113 shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1114 (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
1115 @end table
1116
1117 The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1118 You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1119 @value{GDBN}:
1120
1121 @table @code
1122 @kindex make
1123 @cindex calling make
1124 @item make @var{make-args}
1125 Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1126 arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1127 @end table
1128
1129 @node Commands
1130 @chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1131
1132 You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1133 name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1134 @value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1135 key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1136 show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1137
1138 @menu
1139 * Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1140 * Completion:: Command completion
1141 * Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1142 @end menu
1143
1144 @node Command Syntax
1145 @section Command syntax
1146
1147 A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1148 how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1149 arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1150 command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1151 step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
1152 with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
1153
1154 @cindex abbreviation
1155 @value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1156 unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1157 documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1158 abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1159 equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1160 names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1161 arguments to the @code{help} command.
1162
1163 @cindex repeating commands
1164 @kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
1165 A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
1166 repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
1167 will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1168 repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1169 repeat.
1170
1171 The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1172 @key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1173 exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1174
1175 @value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1176 output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1177 (@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1178 @key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1179 repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1180
1181 @kindex # @r{(a comment)}
1182 @cindex comment
1183 Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1184 nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1185 Files,,Command files}).
1186
1187 @node Completion
1188 @section Command completion
1189
1190 @cindex completion
1191 @cindex word completion
1192 @value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1193 only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1194 are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1195 commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1196
1197 Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1198 of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1199 word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1200 enter it). For example, if you type
1201
1202 @c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1203 @c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1204 @c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1205 @c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1206 @example
1207 (@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1208 @end example
1209
1210 @noindent
1211 @value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1212 the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1213
1214 @example
1215 (@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1216 @end example
1217
1218 @noindent
1219 You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1220 breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1221 @samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1222 were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1223 might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1224 to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1225
1226 If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1227 @key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1228 characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1229 @value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1230 example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1231 begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1232 just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1233 function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1234 example:
1235
1236 @example
1237 (@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1238 @exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
1239 make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1240 make_abs_section make_function_type
1241 make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1242 make_cleanup make_reference_type
1243 make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1244 (@value{GDBP}) b make_
1245 @end example
1246
1247 @noindent
1248 After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1249 partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1250 command.
1251
1252 If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
1253 can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
1254 means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
1255 key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
1256 one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
1257
1258 @cindex quotes in commands
1259 @cindex completion of quoted strings
1260 Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
1261 parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1262 its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1263 situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1264 @value{GDBN} commands.
1265
1266 The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
1267 name of a C++ function. This is because C++ allows function overloading
1268 (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished by argument
1269 type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you may need to
1270 distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name} that takes an
1271 @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version that takes a
1272 @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the word-completion
1273 facilities in this situation, type a single quote @code{'} at the
1274 beginning of the function name. This alerts @value{GDBN} that it may need to
1275 consider more information than usual when you press @key{TAB} or
1276 @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
1277
1278 @example
1279 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
1280 bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1281 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1282 @end example
1283
1284 In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1285 quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1286 completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1287 place:
1288
1289 @example
1290 (@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1291 @exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1292 (@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1293 @end example
1294
1295 @noindent
1296 In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1297 you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1298 completion on an overloaded symbol.
1299
1300 For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
1301 expressions, ,C++ expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
1302 overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
1303 see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
1304
1305
1306 @node Help
1307 @section Getting help
1308 @cindex online documentation
1309 @kindex help
1310
1311 You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
1312 using the command @code{help}.
1313
1314 @table @code
1315 @kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
1316 @item help
1317 @itemx h
1318 You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1319 display a short list of named classes of commands:
1320
1321 @smallexample
1322 (@value{GDBP}) help
1323 List of classes of commands:
1324
1325 aliases -- Aliases of other commands
1326 breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
1327 data -- Examining data
1328 files -- Specifying and examining files
1329 internals -- Maintenance commands
1330 obscure -- Obscure features
1331 running -- Running the program
1332 stack -- Examining the stack
1333 status -- Status inquiries
1334 support -- Support facilities
1335 tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1336 stopping the program
1337 user-defined -- User-defined commands
1338
1339 Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
1340 commands in that class.
1341 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1342 documentation.
1343 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1344 (@value{GDBP})
1345 @end smallexample
1346 @c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
1347
1348 @item help @var{class}
1349 Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1350 list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1351 help display for the class @code{status}:
1352
1353 @smallexample
1354 (@value{GDBP}) help status
1355 Status inquiries.
1356
1357 List of commands:
1358
1359 @c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1360 @c to fit in smallbook page size.
1361 info -- Generic command for showing things
1362 about the program being debugged
1363 show -- Generic command for showing things
1364 about the debugger
1365
1366 Type "help" followed by command name for full
1367 documentation.
1368 Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1369 (@value{GDBP})
1370 @end smallexample
1371
1372 @item help @var{command}
1373 With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1374 short paragraph on how to use that command.
1375
1376 @kindex apropos
1377 @item apropos @var{args}
1378 The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1379 commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1380 @var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1381
1382 @smallexample
1383 apropos reload
1384 @end smallexample
1385
1386 @noindent results in:
1387
1388 @smallexample
1389 @c @group
1390 set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1391 multiple times in one run
1392 show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1393 multiple times in one run
1394 @c @end group
1395 @end smallexample
1396
1397 @kindex complete
1398 @item complete @var{args}
1399 The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1400 for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1401 command you want completed. For example:
1402
1403 @smallexample
1404 complete i
1405 @end smallexample
1406
1407 @noindent results in:
1408
1409 @smallexample
1410 @group
1411 if
1412 ignore
1413 info
1414 inspect
1415 @end group
1416 @end smallexample
1417
1418 @noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1419 @end table
1420
1421 In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1422 and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1423 of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1424 manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1425 under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1426 all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1427
1428 @c @group
1429 @table @code
1430 @kindex info
1431 @kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
1432 @item info
1433 This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1434 program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1435 with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1436 registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1437 You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1438 @w{@code{help info}}.
1439
1440 @kindex set
1441 @item set
1442 You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
1443 @code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1444 @code{set prompt $}.
1445
1446 @kindex show
1447 @item show
1448 In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
1449 @value{GDBN} itself.
1450 You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1451 related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1452 system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1453 which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1454
1455 @kindex info set
1456 To display all the settable parameters and their current
1457 values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1458 @code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1459 @c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1460 @c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1461 @c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1462 @end table
1463 @c @end group
1464
1465 Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1466 exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1467
1468 @table @code
1469 @kindex show version
1470 @cindex version number
1471 @item show version
1472 Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
1473 information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1474 @value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1475 version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1476 commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1477 system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
1478 variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
1479 The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1480 @value{GDBN}.
1481
1482 @kindex show copying
1483 @item show copying
1484 Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1485
1486 @kindex show warranty
1487 @item show warranty
1488 Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
1489 if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
1490
1491 @end table
1492
1493 @node Running
1494 @chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1495
1496 When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1497 debugging information when you compile it.
1498
1499 You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1500 of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1501 your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1502 kill a child process.
1503
1504 @menu
1505 * Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1506 * Starting:: Starting your program
1507 * Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1508 * Environment:: Your program's environment
1509
1510 * Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1511 * Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1512 * Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1513 * Kill Process:: Killing the child process
1514
1515 * Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1516 * Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1517 @end menu
1518
1519 @node Compilation
1520 @section Compiling for debugging
1521
1522 In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1523 debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1524 is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1525 variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1526 and addresses in the executable code.
1527
1528 To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1529 the compiler.
1530
1531 Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1532 options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1533 executables containing debugging information.
1534
1535 @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1536 without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1537 recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1538 program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1539 in pushing your luck.
1540
1541 @cindex optimized code, debugging
1542 @cindex debugging optimized code
1543 When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1544 optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1545 really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1546 exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1547 variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1548 variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1549
1550 Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1551 @samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1552 doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1553 please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1554
1555 Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1556 @w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1557 format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1558
1559 @need 2000
1560 @node Starting
1561 @section Starting your program
1562 @cindex starting
1563 @cindex running
1564
1565 @table @code
1566 @kindex run
1567 @kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
1568 @item run
1569 @itemx r
1570 Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1571 You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1572 argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1573 @value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1574 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
1575
1576 @end table
1577
1578 If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1579 supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1580 that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1581 @code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1582
1583 The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1584 receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1585 information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1586 can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1587 your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1588 divided into four categories:
1589
1590 @table @asis
1591 @item The @emph{arguments.}
1592 Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1593 @code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1594 is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1595 (such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1596 the arguments.
1597 In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1598 @code{SHELL} environment variable.
1599 @xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1600
1601 @item The @emph{environment.}
1602 Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1603 use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1604 environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1605 your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1606
1607 @item The @emph{working directory.}
1608 Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1609 the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1610 @xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1611
1612 @item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1613 Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1614 standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1615 in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1616 set a different device for your program.
1617 @xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1618
1619 @cindex pipes
1620 @emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1621 pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1622 program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1623 wrong program.
1624 @end table
1625
1626 When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1627 immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1628 of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1629 stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1630 or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1631
1632 If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1633 time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1634 table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1635 your current breakpoints.
1636
1637 @node Arguments
1638 @section Your program's arguments
1639
1640 @cindex arguments (to your program)
1641 The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
1642 @code{run} command.
1643 They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1644 performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1645 @code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1646 @value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
1647 the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1648
1649 On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1650 @value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1651 calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1652 the program, not by the shell.
1653
1654 @code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1655 @code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1656
1657 @table @code
1658 @kindex set args
1659 @item set args
1660 Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1661 @code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1662 with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1663 using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1664 it again without arguments.
1665
1666 @kindex show args
1667 @item show args
1668 Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1669 @end table
1670
1671 @node Environment
1672 @section Your program's environment
1673
1674 @cindex environment (of your program)
1675 The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1676 their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1677 your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1678 path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1679 the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1680 debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1681 environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1682
1683 @table @code
1684 @kindex path
1685 @item path @var{directory}
1686 Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
1687 (the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1688 The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
1689 You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1690 system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1691 MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1692 is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
1693
1694 You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1695 working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1696 use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1697 @code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1698 @var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1699 @var{directory} to the search path.
1700 @c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1701 @c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1702
1703 @kindex show paths
1704 @item show paths
1705 Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1706 environment variable).
1707
1708 @kindex show environment
1709 @item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1710 Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1711 your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1712 print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1713 your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1714
1715 @kindex set environment
1716 @item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
1717 Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1718 changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1719 be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1720 any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1721 parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1722 null value.
1723 @c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1724 @c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1725
1726 For example, this command:
1727
1728 @example
1729 set env USER = foo
1730 @end example
1731
1732 @noindent
1733 tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
1734 @samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1735 are not actually required.)
1736
1737 @kindex unset environment
1738 @item unset environment @var{varname}
1739 Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1740 program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1741 @code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1742 rather than assigning it an empty value.
1743 @end table
1744
1745 @emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1746 the shell indicated
1747 by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1748 @code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1749 that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1750 @file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1751 your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1752 files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1753 @file{.profile}.
1754
1755 @node Working Directory
1756 @section Your program's working directory
1757
1758 @cindex working directory (of your program)
1759 Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1760 working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1761 The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1762 from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1763 working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1764
1765 The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1766 that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1767 specify files}.
1768
1769 @table @code
1770 @kindex cd
1771 @item cd @var{directory}
1772 Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1773
1774 @kindex pwd
1775 @item pwd
1776 Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1777 @end table
1778
1779 @node Input/Output
1780 @section Your program's input and output
1781
1782 @cindex redirection
1783 @cindex i/o
1784 @cindex terminal
1785 By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
1786 the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
1787 to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1788 modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1789 running your program.
1790
1791 @table @code
1792 @kindex info terminal
1793 @item info terminal
1794 Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1795 program is using.
1796 @end table
1797
1798 You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1799 redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1800
1801 @example
1802 run > outfile
1803 @end example
1804
1805 @noindent
1806 starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1807
1808 @kindex tty
1809 @cindex controlling terminal
1810 Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1811 with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1812 argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1813 commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1814 process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1815
1816 @example
1817 tty /dev/ttyb
1818 @end example
1819
1820 @noindent
1821 directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1822 default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1823 that as their controlling terminal.
1824
1825 An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1826 effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1827 terminal.
1828
1829 When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1830 command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1831 for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1832
1833 @node Attach
1834 @section Debugging an already-running process
1835 @kindex attach
1836 @cindex attach
1837
1838 @table @code
1839 @item attach @var{process-id}
1840 This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1841 outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1842 targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1843 find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1844 or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1845
1846 @code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1847 executing the command.
1848 @end table
1849
1850 To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1851 which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1852 programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1853 also have permission to send the process a signal.
1854
1855 When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1856 the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1857 the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1858 (@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1859 the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1860 Specify Files}.
1861
1862 The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1863 process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
1864 with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1865 you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1866 can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1867 process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
1868 attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1869
1870 @table @code
1871 @kindex detach
1872 @item detach
1873 When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1874 @code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1875 the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1876 that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1877 are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1878 @code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1879 executing the command.
1880 @end table
1881
1882 If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1883 attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1884 for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1885 control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1886 confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1887 messages}).
1888
1889 @node Kill Process
1890 @section Killing the child process
1891
1892 @table @code
1893 @kindex kill
1894 @item kill
1895 Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1896 @end table
1897
1898 This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1899 running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1900 is running.
1901
1902 On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1903 while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1904 @code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1905 outside the debugger.
1906
1907 The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1908 relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1909 executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1910 next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1911 reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1912 breakpoint settings).
1913
1914 @node Threads
1915 @section Debugging programs with multiple threads
1916
1917 @cindex threads of execution
1918 @cindex multiple threads
1919 @cindex switching threads
1920 In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
1921 may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
1922 of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
1923 the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
1924 that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
1925 modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
1926 registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
1927
1928 @value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
1929 programs:
1930
1931 @itemize @bullet
1932 @item automatic notification of new threads
1933 @item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
1934 @item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
1935 @item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
1936 a command to apply a command to a list of threads
1937 @item thread-specific breakpoints
1938 @end itemize
1939
1940 @quotation
1941 @emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
1942 @value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
1943 If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
1944 effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
1945 from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
1946 like this:
1947
1948 @smallexample
1949 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
1950 (@value{GDBP}) thread 1
1951 Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
1952 see the IDs of currently known threads.
1953 @end smallexample
1954 @c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
1955 @c doesn't support threads"?
1956 @end quotation
1957
1958 @cindex focus of debugging
1959 @cindex current thread
1960 The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
1961 threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
1962 control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
1963 This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
1964 program information from the perspective of the current thread.
1965
1966 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
1967 @cindex thread identifier (system)
1968 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
1969 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
1970 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
1971 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
1972 the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
1973 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
1974 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
1975 LynxOS, you might see
1976
1977 @example
1978 [New process 35 thread 27]
1979 @end example
1980
1981 @noindent
1982 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
1983 the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
1984 further qualifier.
1985
1986 @c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
1987 @c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
1988 @c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
1989 @c program?
1990 @c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
1991 @c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
1992 @c threads ab initio?
1993
1994 @cindex thread number
1995 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
1996 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
1997 number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
1998
1999 @table @code
2000 @kindex info threads
2001 @item info threads
2002 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2003 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2004
2005 @enumerate
2006 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2007
2008 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2009
2010 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2011 @end enumerate
2012
2013 @noindent
2014 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2015 indicates the current thread.
2016
2017 For example,
2018 @end table
2019 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2020
2021 @smallexample
2022 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2023 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2024 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2025 * 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2026 at threadtest.c:68
2027 @end smallexample
2028
2029 On HP-UX systems:
2030
2031 @cindex thread number
2032 @cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2033 For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2034 number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2035 thread in your program.
2036
2037 @cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2038 @cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
2039 @c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2040 @c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2041 @c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2042 Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2043 both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2044 form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2045 whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2046 HP-UX, you see
2047
2048 @example
2049 [New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2050 @end example
2051
2052 @noindent
2053 when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
2054
2055 @table @code
2056 @kindex info threads
2057 @item info threads
2058 Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2059 program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2060
2061 @enumerate
2062 @item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2063
2064 @item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2065
2066 @item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2067 @end enumerate
2068
2069 @noindent
2070 An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2071 indicates the current thread.
2072
2073 For example,
2074 @end table
2075 @c end table here to get a little more width for example
2076
2077 @example
2078 (@value{GDBP}) info threads
2079 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2080 at quicksort.c:137
2081 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2082 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2083 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2084 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2085 @end example
2086
2087 @table @code
2088 @kindex thread @var{threadno}
2089 @item thread @var{threadno}
2090 Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2091 argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2092 shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2093 @value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2094 you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2095
2096 @smallexample
2097 @c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2098 (@value{GDBP}) thread 2
2099 [Switching to process 35 thread 23]
2100 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2101 @end smallexample
2102
2103 @noindent
2104 As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2105 @samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
2106 threads.
2107
2108 @kindex thread apply
2109 @item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2110 The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2111 more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2112 with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2113 @value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
2114 threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2115 @code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
2116 @end table
2117
2118 @cindex automatic thread selection
2119 @cindex switching threads automatically
2120 @cindex threads, automatic switching
2121 Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2122 signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2123 signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2124 message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2125 thread.
2126
2127 @xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2128 more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2129 programs with multiple threads.
2130
2131 @xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2132 watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
2133
2134 @node Processes
2135 @section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2136
2137 @cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2138 @cindex multiple processes
2139 @cindex processes, multiple
2140 On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2141 programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2142 function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2143 parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2144 set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2145 will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2146 will cause it to terminate.
2147
2148 However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2149 which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2150 the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2151 only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2152 so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2153 on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2154 get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2155 @value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
2156 the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
2157 the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
2158
2159 On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2160 debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2161 @code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
2162
2163 By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2164 the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2165
2166 If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2167 use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2168
2169 @table @code
2170 @kindex set follow-fork-mode
2171 @item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2172 Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2173 @code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2174 process. The @var{mode} can be:
2175
2176 @table @code
2177 @item parent
2178 The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2179 unimpeded. This is the default.
2180
2181 @item child
2182 The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2183 unimpeded.
2184
2185 @item ask
2186 The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2187 @end table
2188
2189 @item show follow-fork-mode
2190 Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
2191 @end table
2192
2193 If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2194 @code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2195 breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2196 @code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2197 the child process's @code{main}.
2198
2199 When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2200 child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2201
2202 If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2203 call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2204 use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2205 argument.
2206
2207 You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2208 a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2209 Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
2210
2211 @node Stopping
2212 @chapter Stopping and Continuing
2213
2214 The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2215 program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2216 trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2217
2218 Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2219 such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2220 @value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2221 change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2222 continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2223 ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2224 explicitly request this information at any time.
2225
2226 @table @code
2227 @kindex info program
2228 @item info program
2229 Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
2230 running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
2231 @end table
2232
2233 @menu
2234 * Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2235 * Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
2236 * Signals:: Signals
2237 * Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
2238 @end menu
2239
2240 @node Breakpoints
2241 @section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2242
2243 @cindex breakpoints
2244 A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2245 the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2246 control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2247 breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2248 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2249 should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2250 program.
2251
2252 In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2253 breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2254 a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2255 is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2256 not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2257 arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2258
2259 @cindex watchpoints
2260 @cindex memory tracing
2261 @cindex breakpoint on memory address
2262 @cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2263 A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2264 when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2265 command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2266 watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2267 any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2268 and watchpoints using the same commands.
2269
2270 You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2271 whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2272 Automatic display}.
2273
2274 @cindex catchpoints
2275 @cindex breakpoint on events
2276 A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
2277 when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C++
2278 exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2279 different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2280 catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2281 other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
2282 @code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
2283
2284 @cindex breakpoint numbers
2285 @cindex numbers for breakpoints
2286 @value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2287 catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2288 starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2289 features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2290 breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2291 @dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2292 enable it again.
2293
2294 @cindex breakpoint ranges
2295 @cindex ranges of breakpoints
2296 Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2297 operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2298 @samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2299 hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2300 all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2301
2302 @menu
2303 * Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2304 * Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2305 * Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2306 * Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2307 * Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2308 * Conditions:: Break conditions
2309 * Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
2310 * Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
2311 * Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
2312 @end menu
2313
2314 @node Set Breaks
2315 @subsection Setting breakpoints
2316
2317 @c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
2318 @c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2319 @c
2320 @c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2321
2322 @kindex break
2323 @kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2324 @vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
2325 @cindex latest breakpoint
2326 Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
2327 @code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
2328 number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
2329 Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2330 convenience variables.
2331
2332 You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2333
2334 @table @code
2335 @item break @var{function}
2336 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
2337 When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
2338 C++, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
2339 @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
2340
2341 @item break +@var{offset}
2342 @itemx break -@var{offset}
2343 Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
2344 at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2345 (@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
2346
2347 @item break @var{linenum}
2348 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
2349 The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2350 The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
2351 code on that line.
2352
2353 @item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2354 Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2355
2356 @item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2357 Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2358 @var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2359 superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2360 functions.
2361
2362 @item break *@var{address}
2363 Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2364 breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2365 information or source files.
2366
2367 @item break
2368 When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2369 the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2370 (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2371 innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2372 returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2373 @code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2374 that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2375 @code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2376 the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2377 inside loops.
2378
2379 @value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2380 least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2381 would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2382 breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2383 existed when your program stopped.
2384
2385 @item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2386 Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2387 @var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2388 value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2389 @samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2390 above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2391 ,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2392
2393 @kindex tbreak
2394 @item tbreak @var{args}
2395 Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2396 same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2397 way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2398 program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2399
2400 @kindex hbreak
2401 @item hbreak @var{args}
2402 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2403 @code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
2404 breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2405 have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
2406 debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2407 changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2408 provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2409 will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2410 address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2411 breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2412 example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2413 @value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2414 or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2415 (@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2416
2417 @kindex thbreak
2418 @item thbreak @var{args}
2419 Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2420 are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
2421 the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
2422 the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2423 first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
2424 command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2425 may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2426 See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
2427
2428 @kindex rbreak
2429 @cindex regular expression
2430 @item rbreak @var{regex}
2431 Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
2432 @var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2433 matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2434 breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2435 the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2436 them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2437
2438 The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2439 like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2440 shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2441 an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2442 @code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2443 match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
2444
2445 When debugging C++ programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
2446 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2447 classes.
2448
2449 @kindex info breakpoints
2450 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2451 @item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2452 @itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2453 @itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2454 Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2455 not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2456
2457 @table @emph
2458 @item Breakpoint Numbers
2459 @item Type
2460 Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2461 @item Disposition
2462 Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2463 @item Enabled or Disabled
2464 Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2465 that are not enabled.
2466 @item Address
2467 Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
2468 @item What
2469 Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2470 line number.
2471 @end table
2472
2473 @noindent
2474 If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2475 the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2476 are listed after that.
2477
2478 @noindent
2479 @code{info break} with a breakpoint
2480 number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2481 convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2482 the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
2483 listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
2484
2485 @noindent
2486 @code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2487 has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2488 @code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2489 hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2490 was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2491 will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2492 @end table
2493
2494 @value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2495 your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2496 the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2497 (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2498
2499 @cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2500 @cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
2501 @value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for special
2502 purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C programs).
2503 These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers, starting with
2504 @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
2505
2506 You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
2507 @samp{maint info breakpoints}.
2508
2509 @table @code
2510 @kindex maint info breakpoints
2511 @item maint info breakpoints
2512 Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
2513 breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
2514 internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
2515 breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
2516 is shown:
2517
2518 @table @code
2519 @item breakpoint
2520 Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
2521
2522 @item watchpoint
2523 Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
2524
2525 @item longjmp
2526 Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
2527 @code{longjmp} calls.
2528
2529 @item longjmp resume
2530 Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
2531
2532 @item until
2533 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
2534
2535 @item finish
2536 Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
2537
2538 @item shlib events
2539 Shared library events.
2540
2541 @end table
2542
2543 @end table
2544
2545
2546 @node Set Watchpoints
2547 @subsection Setting watchpoints
2548
2549 @cindex setting watchpoints
2550 @cindex software watchpoints
2551 @cindex hardware watchpoints
2552 You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2553 expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2554 this may happen.
2555
2556 Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2557 hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
2558 program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2559 times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2560 catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2561 culprit.)
2562
2563 On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2564 @value{GDBN} includes support for
2565 hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2566 program.
2567
2568 @table @code
2569 @kindex watch
2570 @item watch @var{expr}
2571 Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2572 is written into by the program and its value changes.
2573
2574 @kindex rwatch
2575 @item rwatch @var{expr}
2576 Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
2577
2578 @kindex awatch
2579 @item awatch @var{expr}
2580 Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
2581 by the program.
2582
2583 @kindex info watchpoints
2584 @item info watchpoints
2585 This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2586 it is the same as @code{info break}.
2587 @end table
2588
2589 @value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2590 watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2591 value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2592 cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2593 executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2594 statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2595
2596 When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2597
2598 @example
2599 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2600 @end example
2601
2602 @noindent
2603 if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2604
2605 Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2606 hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2607 value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2608 every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2609 that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2610 hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2611 will print a message like this:
2612
2613 @smallexample
2614 Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2615 @end smallexample
2616
2617 Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2618 data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2619 watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2620 can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2621 cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2622 double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2623 wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2624 into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2625
2626 If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2627 to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2628 Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2629 time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2630 able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2631 warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2632
2633 @smallexample
2634 Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2635 @end smallexample
2636
2637 @noindent
2638 If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2639
2640 The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2641 or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2642 data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2643 hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2644 both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2645 watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2646 @strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2647 watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
2648 @value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2649 Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2650
2651 If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2652 any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
2653 kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2654
2655 @value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2656 (automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2657 they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2658 which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2659 being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2660 and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2661 rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2662 way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2663 @code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2664
2665 @quotation
2666 @cindex watchpoints and threads
2667 @cindex threads and watchpoints
2668 @emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2669 usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2670 can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2671 you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2672 thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2673 can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2674 @value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2675 the expression.
2676
2677 @c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
2678 @emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2679 have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2680 watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2681 single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2682 change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2683 confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2684 software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2685 when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2686 watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
2687 @end quotation
2688
2689 @node Set Catchpoints
2690 @subsection Setting catchpoints
2691 @cindex catchpoints, setting
2692 @cindex exception handlers
2693 @cindex event handling
2694
2695 You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
2696 kinds of program events, such as C++ exceptions or the loading of a
2697 shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2698
2699 @table @code
2700 @kindex catch
2701 @item catch @var{event}
2702 Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2703 @table @code
2704 @item throw
2705 @kindex catch throw
2706 The throwing of a C++ exception.
2707
2708 @item catch
2709 @kindex catch catch
2710 The catching of a C++ exception.
2711
2712 @item exec
2713 @kindex catch exec
2714 A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2715
2716 @item fork
2717 @kindex catch fork
2718 A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2719
2720 @item vfork
2721 @kindex catch vfork
2722 A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2723
2724 @item load
2725 @itemx load @var{libname}
2726 @kindex catch load
2727 The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2728 @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2729
2730 @item unload
2731 @itemx unload @var{libname}
2732 @kindex catch unload
2733 The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2734 of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2735 @end table
2736
2737 @item tcatch @var{event}
2738 Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2739 automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2740
2741 @end table
2742
2743 Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2744
2745 There are currently some limitations to C++ exception handling
2746 (@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2747
2748 @itemize @bullet
2749 @item
2750 If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2751 control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2752 raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2753 returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2754 simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2755 that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2756 you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2757 disabled within interactive calls.
2758
2759 @item
2760 You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2761
2762 @item
2763 You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2764 @end itemize
2765
2766 @cindex raise exceptions
2767 Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2768 if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2769 stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2770 can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2771 breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2772 out where the exception was raised.
2773
2774 To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
2775 knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C++, exceptions are
2776 raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2777 which has the following ANSI C interface:
2778
2779 @example
2780 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
2781 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2782 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
2783 @end example
2784
2785 @noindent
2786 To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2787 unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2788 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2789
2790 With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2791 that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2792 a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2793 breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2794 raised.
2795
2796
2797 @node Delete Breaks
2798 @subsection Deleting breakpoints
2799
2800 @cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2801 @cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2802 It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2803 catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2804 to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2805 breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2806
2807 With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2808 where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2809 delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2810 their breakpoint numbers.
2811
2812 It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2813 automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2814 when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2815
2816 @table @code
2817 @kindex clear
2818 @item clear
2819 Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2820 selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2821 the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2822 breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2823
2824 @item clear @var{function}
2825 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2826 Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2827
2828 @item clear @var{linenum}
2829 @itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2830 Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2831
2832 @cindex delete breakpoints
2833 @kindex delete
2834 @kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
2835 @item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2836 Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2837 ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
2838 breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2839 confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2840 @end table
2841
2842 @node Disabling
2843 @subsection Disabling breakpoints
2844
2845 @kindex disable breakpoints
2846 @kindex enable breakpoints
2847 Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2848 prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2849 it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2850 that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2851
2852 You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2853 the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2854 or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2855 @code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2856 catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2857
2858 A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2859 states of enablement:
2860
2861 @itemize @bullet
2862 @item
2863 Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2864 with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2865 @item
2866 Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2867 @item
2868 Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
2869 disabled.
2870 @item
2871 Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
2872 immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2873 set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
2874 @end itemize
2875
2876 You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2877 watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2878
2879 @table @code
2880 @kindex disable breakpoints
2881 @kindex disable
2882 @kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
2883 @item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2884 Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2885 listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2886 options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2887 case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2888 @code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2889
2890 @kindex enable breakpoints
2891 @kindex enable
2892 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2893 Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2894 become effective once again in stopping your program.
2895
2896 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
2897 Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2898 of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2899
2900 @item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
2901 Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2902 deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2903 @end table
2904
2905 @c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2906 @c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
2907 Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2908 ,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2909 subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2910 the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2911 breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2912 breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2913 stepping}.)
2914
2915 @node Conditions
2916 @subsection Break conditions
2917 @cindex conditional breakpoints
2918 @cindex breakpoint conditions
2919
2920 @c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
2921 @c in particular for a watchpoint?
2922 The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2923 specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2924 breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2925 programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2926 a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2927 and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2928
2929 This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2930 situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2931 when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2932 by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2933 @samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2934
2935 Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2936 since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2937 it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2938 and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2939 one.
2940
2941 Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2942 your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2943 that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2944 format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2945 unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2946 that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2947 program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
2948 breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2949 conditions for the
2950 purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2951 (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2952
2953 Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2954 @samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2955 Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2956 with the @code{condition} command.
2957
2958 You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
2959 The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
2960 @code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
2961 catchpoint.
2962
2963 @table @code
2964 @kindex condition
2965 @item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
2966 Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
2967 watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
2968 breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
2969 @var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
2970 @code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
2971 syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
2972 referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
2973 symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
2974 prints an error message:
2975
2976 @example
2977 No symbol "foo" in current context.
2978 @end example
2979
2980 @noindent
2981 @value{GDBN} does
2982 not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
2983 command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
2984 @code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
2985
2986 @item condition @var{bnum}
2987 Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
2988 an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
2989 @end table
2990
2991 @cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
2992 A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
2993 breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
2994 useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
2995 count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
2996 is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
2997 therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
2998 ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
2999 the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3000 value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3001 your program reaches it.
3002
3003 @table @code
3004 @kindex ignore
3005 @item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3006 Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3007 The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3008 execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3009 takes no action.
3010
3011 To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3012 a count of zero.
3013
3014 When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3015 breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3016 @code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3017 Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3018
3019 If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3020 condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3021 @value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3022
3023 You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3024 as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3025 is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3026 variables}.
3027 @end table
3028
3029 Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3030
3031
3032 @node Break Commands
3033 @subsection Breakpoint command lists
3034
3035 @cindex breakpoint commands
3036 You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3037 commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3038 example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3039 enable other breakpoints.
3040
3041 @table @code
3042 @kindex commands
3043 @kindex end
3044 @item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3045 @itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3046 @itemx end
3047 Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3048 themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3049 @code{end} to terminate the commands.
3050
3051 To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3052 follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3053
3054 With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3055 breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3056 recently encountered).
3057 @end table
3058
3059 Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3060 disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3061
3062 You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3063 use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3064 that resumes execution.
3065
3066 Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3067 execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3068 (even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3069 another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3070 ambiguities about which list to execute.
3071
3072 @kindex silent
3073 If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3074 usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3075 be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3076 then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3077 see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3078 meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3079
3080 The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3081 print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3082 breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3083
3084 For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3085 value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3086
3087 @example
3088 break foo if x>0
3089 commands
3090 silent
3091 printf "x is %d\n",x
3092 cont
3093 end
3094 @end example
3095
3096 One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3097 you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3098 of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3099 erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3100 to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3101 so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3102 command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3103
3104 @example
3105 break 403
3106 commands
3107 silent
3108 set x = y + 4
3109 cont
3110 end
3111 @end example
3112
3113 @node Breakpoint Menus
3114 @subsection Breakpoint menus
3115 @cindex overloading
3116 @cindex symbol overloading
3117
3118 Some programming languages (notably C++) permit a single function name
3119 to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3120 This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3121 @samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3122 a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3123 something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3124 particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3125 you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3126 waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3127 options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3128 sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3129 @kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3130 breakpoints.
3131
3132 For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3133 breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3134 We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3135
3136 @c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3137 @smallexample
3138 @group
3139 (@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3140 [0] cancel
3141 [1] all
3142 [2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3143 [3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3144 [4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3145 [5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3146 [6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3147 [7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3148 > 2 4 6
3149 Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3150 Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3151 Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3152 Multiple breakpoints were set.
3153 Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3154 breakpoints.
3155 (@value{GDBP})
3156 @end group
3157 @end smallexample
3158
3159 @c @ifclear BARETARGET
3160 @node Error in Breakpoints
3161 @subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
3162 @c
3163 @c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3164 @c
3165 Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3166 any other process is running that program. In this situation,
3167 attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
3168 @value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3169
3170 @example
3171 Cannot insert breakpoints.
3172 The same program may be running in another process.
3173 @end example
3174
3175 When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3176
3177 @enumerate
3178 @item
3179 Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3180
3181 @item
3182 Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
3183 name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
3184 that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
3185 Then start your program again.
3186
3187 @item
3188 Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3189 linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3190 to nonsharable executables.
3191 @end enumerate
3192 @c @end ifclear
3193
3194 A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3195 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3196
3197 @c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3198 @c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3199 @smallexample
3200 Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3201 You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3202 @end smallexample
3203
3204 @noindent
3205 This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3206 only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3207 watchpoints it needs to insert.
3208
3209 When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3210 hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3211
3212
3213 @node Continuing and Stepping
3214 @section Continuing and stepping
3215
3216 @cindex stepping
3217 @cindex continuing
3218 @cindex resuming execution
3219 @dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3220 completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3221 one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3222 line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
3223 particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3224 your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
3225 it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3226 @samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
3227
3228 @table @code
3229 @kindex continue
3230 @kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3231 @kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
3232 @item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3233 @itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3234 @itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3235 Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3236 any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3237 @var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3238 ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3239 @code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3240
3241 The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3242 stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3243 @code{continue} is ignored.
3244
3245 The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3246 debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3247 purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3248 @code{continue}.
3249 @end table
3250
3251 To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3252 (@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3253 calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3254 different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3255
3256 A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3257 (@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3258 beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3259 is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3260 and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3261 interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3262
3263 @table @code
3264 @kindex step
3265 @kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
3266 @item step
3267 Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3268 line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3269 abbreviated @code{s}.
3270
3271 @quotation
3272 @c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3273 @c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3274 @c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3275 @c distinction here.
3276 @emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3277 within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3278 execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3279 debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3280 is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3281 without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3282 below.
3283 @end quotation
3284
3285 The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3286 line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3287 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3288 to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3289 the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3290 called within the line.
3291
3292 Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3293 number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
3294 @code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
3295 on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
3296 was any debugging information about the routine.
3297
3298 @item step @var{count}
3299 Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
3300 breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3301 @var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
3302
3303 @kindex next
3304 @kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
3305 @item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3306 Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
3307 This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3308 the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3309 control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3310 that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3311 is abbreviated @code{n}.
3312
3313 An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3314
3315
3316 @c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3317 @c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3318 @c
3319 @c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3320 @c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3321 @c function are executed without stopping.
3322
3323 The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3324 source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3325 @code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
3326
3327 @kindex set step-mode
3328 @item set step-mode
3329 @cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3330 @cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3331 @itemx set step-mode on
3332 The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
3333 stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3334 information rather than stepping over it.
3335
3336 This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3337 machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3338 want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
3339
3340 @item set step-mode off
3341 Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
3342 debug information. This is the default.
3343
3344 @kindex finish
3345 @item finish
3346 Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3347 returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3348
3349 Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3350 ,Returning from a function}).
3351
3352 @kindex until
3353 @kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
3354 @item until
3355 @itemx u
3356 Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3357 current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3358 stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3359 command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3360 automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3361 than the address of the jump.
3362
3363 This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3364 though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3365 exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3366 simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3367 through the next iteration.
3368
3369 @code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3370 stack frame.
3371
3372 @code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3373 of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3374 example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3375 (@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3376 @code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3377
3378 @example
3379 (@value{GDBP}) f
3380 #0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3381 206 expand_input();
3382 (@value{GDBP}) until
3383 195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3384 @end example
3385
3386 This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3387 generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3388 start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3389 written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3390 to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3391 expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3392 statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3393
3394 @code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3395 instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3396 argument.
3397
3398 @item until @var{location}
3399 @itemx u @var{location}
3400 Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3401 reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3402 the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3403 ,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3404 and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3405
3406 @kindex stepi
3407 @kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
3408 @item stepi
3409 @itemx stepi @var{arg}
3410 @itemx si
3411 Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3412
3413 It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3414 instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3415 instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3416 Display,, Automatic display}.
3417
3418 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3419
3420 @need 750
3421 @kindex nexti
3422 @kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
3423 @item nexti
3424 @itemx nexti @var{arg}
3425 @itemx ni
3426 Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3427 proceed until the function returns.
3428
3429 An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3430 @end table
3431
3432 @node Signals
3433 @section Signals
3434 @cindex signals
3435
3436 A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3437 operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3438 kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
3439 signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
3440 @code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3441 memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3442 the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3443 requested an alarm).
3444
3445 @cindex fatal signals
3446 Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3447 functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
3448 errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
3449 program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3450 @code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3451 fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3452
3453 @value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3454 program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3455 signal.
3456
3457 @cindex handling signals
3458 Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to ignore non-erroneous signals like @code{SIGALRM}
3459 (so as not to interfere with their role in the functioning of your program)
3460 but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3461 You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3462
3463 @table @code
3464 @kindex info signals
3465 @item info signals
3466 @itemx info handle
3467 Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3468 handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3469 the defined types of signals.
3470
3471 @code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
3472
3473 @kindex handle
3474 @item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
3475 Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can
3476 be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the @samp{SIG} at the
3477 beginning). The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
3478 @end table
3479
3480 @c @group
3481 The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3482 Their full names are:
3483
3484 @table @code
3485 @item nostop
3486 @value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3487 still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3488
3489 @item stop
3490 @value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3491 the @code{print} keyword as well.
3492
3493 @item print
3494 @value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3495
3496 @item noprint
3497 @value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3498 implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3499
3500 @item pass
3501 @value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3502 can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
3503 and not handled.
3504
3505 @item nopass
3506 @value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
3507 @end table
3508 @c @end group
3509
3510 When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3511 program until you
3512 continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3513 effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3514 after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3515 command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3516 program sees that signal when you continue.
3517
3518 You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3519 seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3520 or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3521 due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3522 values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3523 execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3524 a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3525 you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
3526 program a signal}.
3527
3528 @node Thread Stops
3529 @section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3530
3531 When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3532 programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3533 breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3534
3535 @table @code
3536 @cindex breakpoints and threads
3537 @cindex thread breakpoints
3538 @kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3539 @item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3540 @itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3541 @var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3542 writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3543
3544 Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3545 to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3546 particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3547 numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3548 column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3549
3550 If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3551 breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3552 program.
3553
3554 You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3555 well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3556 breakpoint condition, like this:
3557
3558 @smallexample
3559 (@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
3560 @end smallexample
3561
3562 @end table
3563
3564 @cindex stopped threads
3565 @cindex threads, stopped
3566 Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3567 @emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3568 allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3569 switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3570 underfoot.
3571
3572 @cindex continuing threads
3573 @cindex threads, continuing
3574 Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3575 executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
3576 like @code{step} or @code{next}.
3577
3578 In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3579 Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3580 system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3581 execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3582 single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3583 statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3584 stops.
3585
3586 You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3587 continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3588 thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3589 first thread completes whatever you requested.
3590
3591 On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3592 thread to run.
3593
3594 @table @code
3595 @item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3596 Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3597 locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3598 current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3599 mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3600 ``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3601 stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
3602 when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
3603 function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
3604 like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
3605 thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
3606 @value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
3607
3608 @item show scheduler-locking
3609 Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3610 @end table
3611
3612
3613 @node Stack
3614 @chapter Examining the Stack
3615
3616 When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3617 stopped and how it got there.
3618
3619 @cindex call stack
3620 Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3621 is generated.
3622 That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3623 the arguments of the call,
3624 and the local variables of the function being called.
3625 The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
3626 The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3627 stack}.
3628
3629 When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3630 stack allow you to see all of this information.
3631
3632 @cindex selected frame
3633 One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3634 @value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3635 particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3636 your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3637 special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3638 interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3639
3640 When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
3641 currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
3642 @code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3643
3644 @menu
3645 * Frames:: Stack frames
3646 * Backtrace:: Backtraces
3647 * Selection:: Selecting a frame
3648 * Frame Info:: Information on a frame
3649
3650 @end menu
3651
3652 @node Frames
3653 @section Stack frames
3654
3655 @cindex frame, definition
3656 @cindex stack frame
3657 The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3658 frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3659 with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3660 to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3661 which the function is executing.
3662
3663 @cindex initial frame
3664 @cindex outermost frame
3665 @cindex innermost frame
3666 When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3667 function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3668 @dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3669 made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3670 is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3671 the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3672 actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3673 recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3674
3675 @cindex frame pointer
3676 Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3677 stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3678 kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3679 address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3680 in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3681 going on in that frame.
3682
3683 @cindex frame number
3684 @value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3685 zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3686 and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3687 they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3688 frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3689
3690 @c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3691 @c underflow problems.
3692 @cindex frameless execution
3693 Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
3694 without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3695 @example
3696 @samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3697 @end example
3698 generates functions without a frame.)
3699 This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3700 the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3701 with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3702 has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3703 it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3704 correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3705 no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3706
3707 @table @code
3708 @kindex frame@r{, command}
3709 @cindex current stack frame
3710 @item frame @var{args}
3711 The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
3712 and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
3713 address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3714 @code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
3715
3716 @kindex select-frame
3717 @cindex selecting frame silently
3718 @item select-frame
3719 The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3720 to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3721 @code{frame}.
3722 @end table
3723
3724 @node Backtrace
3725 @section Backtraces
3726
3727 @cindex backtraces
3728 @cindex tracebacks
3729 @cindex stack traces
3730 A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3731 line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3732 frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3733 stack.
3734
3735 @table @code
3736 @kindex backtrace
3737 @kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
3738 @item backtrace
3739 @itemx bt
3740 Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3741 frames in the stack.
3742
3743 You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3744 character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3745
3746 @item backtrace @var{n}
3747 @itemx bt @var{n}
3748 Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3749
3750 @item backtrace -@var{n}
3751 @itemx bt -@var{n}
3752 Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3753 @end table
3754
3755 @kindex where
3756 @kindex info stack
3757 @kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
3758 The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3759 are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3760
3761 Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3762 The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3763 print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3764 line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3765 counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3766 line number.
3767
3768 Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3769 @samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3770
3771 @smallexample
3772 @group
3773 #0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
3774 at builtin.c:993
3775 #1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3776 #2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3777 at macro.c:71
3778 (More stack frames follow...)
3779 @end group
3780 @end smallexample
3781
3782 @noindent
3783 The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3784 value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3785 code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3786
3787 @node Selection
3788 @section Selecting a frame
3789
3790 Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3791 whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3792 selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3793 of the stack frame just selected.
3794
3795 @table @code
3796 @kindex frame@r{, selecting}
3797 @kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
3798 @item frame @var{n}
3799 @itemx f @var{n}
3800 Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3801 (currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3802 innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3803 @code{main}.
3804
3805 @item frame @var{addr}
3806 @itemx f @var{addr}
3807 Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3808 chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3809 impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3810 addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3811 switches between them.
3812
3813 On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3814 select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3815
3816 On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3817 pointer and a program counter.
3818
3819 On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3820 pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3821 @c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3822 @c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3823 @c as of 27 Jan 1994.
3824
3825 @kindex up
3826 @item up @var{n}
3827 Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3828 advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3829 that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3830
3831 @kindex down
3832 @kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
3833 @item down @var{n}
3834 Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3835 advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3836 that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3837 abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3838 @end table
3839
3840 All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3841 frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3842 arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
3843 frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
3844
3845 @need 1000
3846 For example:
3847
3848 @smallexample
3849 @group
3850 (@value{GDBP}) up
3851 #1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3852 at env.c:10
3853 10 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3854 @end group
3855 @end smallexample
3856
3857 After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3858 prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3859 @xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3860
3861 @table @code
3862 @kindex down-silently
3863 @kindex up-silently
3864 @item up-silently @var{n}
3865 @itemx down-silently @var{n}
3866 These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3867 respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3868 causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3869 in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3870 distracting.
3871 @end table
3872
3873 @node Frame Info
3874 @section Information about a frame
3875
3876 There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3877 stack frame.
3878
3879 @table @code
3880 @item frame
3881 @itemx f
3882 When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3883 frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3884 selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3885 argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3886 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3887
3888 @kindex info frame
3889 @kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
3890 @item info frame
3891 @itemx info f
3892 This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3893 including:
3894
3895 @itemize @bullet
3896 @item
3897 the address of the frame
3898 @item
3899 the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3900 @item
3901 the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3902 @item
3903 the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3904 @item
3905 the address of the frame's arguments
3906 @item
3907 the address of the frame's local variables
3908 @item
3909 the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3910 @item
3911 which registers were saved in the frame
3912 @end itemize
3913
3914 @noindent The verbose description is useful when
3915 something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3916 the usual conventions.
3917
3918 @item info frame @var{addr}
3919 @itemx info f @var{addr}
3920 Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3921 selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3922 command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3923 architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3924 @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3925
3926 @kindex info args
3927 @item info args
3928 Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3929
3930 @item info locals
3931 @kindex info locals
3932 Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3933 line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3934 accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3935
3936 @kindex info catch
3937 @cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3938 @cindex exception handlers, how to list
3939 @item info catch
3940 Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3941 current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3942 exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3943 @code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3944 @xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
3945
3946 @end table
3947
3948
3949 @node Source
3950 @chapter Examining Source Files
3951
3952 @value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
3953 information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
3954 used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
3955 the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
3956 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
3957 execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
3958 source files by explicit command.
3959
3960 If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
3961 prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
3962 @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
3963
3964 @menu
3965 * List:: Printing source lines
3966 * Search:: Searching source files
3967 * Source Path:: Specifying source directories
3968 * Machine Code:: Source and machine code
3969 @end menu
3970
3971 @node List
3972 @section Printing source lines
3973
3974 @kindex list
3975 @kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
3976 To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
3977 (abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
3978 There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
3979
3980 Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
3981
3982 @table @code
3983 @item list @var{linenum}
3984 Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
3985 current source file.
3986
3987 @item list @var{function}
3988 Print lines centered around the beginning of function
3989 @var{function}.
3990
3991 @item list
3992 Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
3993 @code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
3994 printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
3995 as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
3996 Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
3997
3998 @item list -
3999 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4000 @end table
4001
4002 By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4003 the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4004
4005 @table @code
4006 @kindex set listsize
4007 @item set listsize @var{count}
4008 Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4009 the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4010
4011 @kindex show listsize
4012 @item show listsize
4013 Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4014 @end table
4015
4016 Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4017 so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4018 than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4019 argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4020 each repetition moves up in the source file.
4021
4022 @cindex linespec
4023 In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4024 @dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
4025 of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
4026 Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4027
4028 @table @code
4029 @item list @var{linespec}
4030 Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4031
4032 @item list @var{first},@var{last}
4033 Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4034 linespecs.
4035
4036 @item list ,@var{last}
4037 Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4038
4039 @item list @var{first},
4040 Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4041
4042 @item list +
4043 Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4044
4045 @item list -
4046 Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4047
4048 @item list
4049 As described in the preceding table.
4050 @end table
4051
4052 Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4053 kinds of linespec.
4054
4055 @table @code
4056 @item @var{number}
4057 Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4058 When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4059 the same source file as the first linespec.
4060
4061 @item +@var{offset}
4062 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4063 When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4064 two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4065 first linespec.
4066
4067 @item -@var{offset}
4068 Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4069
4070 @item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4071 Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4072
4073 @item @var{function}
4074 Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4075 For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4076
4077 @item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4078 Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4079 function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4080 file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4081 identically named functions in different source files.
4082
4083 @item *@var{address}
4084 Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4085 @var{address} may be any expression.
4086 @end table
4087
4088 @node Search
4089 @section Searching source files
4090 @cindex searching
4091 @kindex reverse-search
4092
4093 There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4094 regular expression.
4095
4096 @table @code
4097 @kindex search
4098 @kindex forward-search
4099 @item forward-search @var{regexp}
4100 @itemx search @var{regexp}
4101 The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4102 starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
4103 @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
4104 synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4105 @code{fo}.
4106
4107 @item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4108 The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4109 with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4110 for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4111 this command as @code{rev}.
4112 @end table
4113
4114 @node Source Path
4115 @section Specifying source directories
4116
4117 @cindex source path
4118 @cindex directories for source files
4119 Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4120 files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4121 the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4122 session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4123 this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4124 it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4125 in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4126 the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4127 the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4128 path.
4129
4130 If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4131 object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4132 too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4133 compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4134 last resort.
4135
4136 Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4137 any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4138 each line is in the file.
4139
4140 @kindex directory
4141 @kindex dir
4142 When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4143 and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
4144 To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4145
4146 @table @code
4147 @item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4148 @item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4149 Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
4150 directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4151 (@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4152 part of absolute file names) or
4153 whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4154 path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4155
4156 @kindex cdir
4157 @kindex cwd
4158 @vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4159 @vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
4160 @cindex compilation directory
4161 @cindex current directory
4162 @cindex working directory
4163 @cindex directory, current
4164 @cindex directory, compilation
4165 You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4166 directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4167 working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4168 tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4169 session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4170 directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4171
4172 @item directory
4173 Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4174
4175 @c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4176 @c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4177
4178 @item show directories
4179 @kindex show directories
4180 Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4181 @end table
4182
4183 If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4184 interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4185 versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4186
4187 @enumerate
4188 @item
4189 Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4190
4191 @item
4192 Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4193 directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4194 directories in one command.
4195 @end enumerate
4196
4197 @node Machine Code
4198 @section Source and machine code
4199
4200 You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4201 addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4202 a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
4203 mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
4204 line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
4205 well as hex.
4206
4207 @table @code
4208 @kindex info line
4209 @item info line @var{linespec}
4210 Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4211 source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4212 the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4213 source lines}).
4214 @end table
4215
4216 For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4217 the object code for the first line of function
4218 @code{m4_changequote}:
4219
4220 @c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4221 @c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
4222 @smallexample
4223 (@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
4224 Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4225 @end smallexample
4226
4227 @noindent
4228 We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4229 @var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4230 @smallexample
4231 (@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4232 Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4233 @end smallexample
4234
4235 @cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
4236 @kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
4237 After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4238 is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4239 sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4240 ,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4241 convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4242 variables}).
4243
4244 @table @code
4245 @kindex disassemble
4246 @cindex assembly instructions
4247 @cindex instructions, assembly
4248 @cindex machine instructions
4249 @cindex listing machine instructions
4250 @item disassemble
4251 This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4252 instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4253 program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4254 command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4255 surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4256 (first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4257 @end table
4258
4259 The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4260 HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4261
4262 @smallexample
4263 (@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4264 Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
4265 0x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
4266 0x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
4267 0x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4268 0x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
4269 0x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
4270 0x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
4271 0x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
4272 0x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4273 End of assembler dump.
4274 @end smallexample
4275
4276 Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4277 mnemonics or other syntax.
4278
4279 @table @code
4280 @kindex set disassembly-flavor
4281 @cindex assembly instructions
4282 @cindex instructions, assembly
4283 @cindex machine instructions
4284 @cindex listing machine instructions
4285 @cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4286 @cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4287 @item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
4288 Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4289 program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4290
4291 Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
4292 can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4293 The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4294 assemblers for x86-based targets.
4295 @end table
4296
4297
4298 @node Data
4299 @chapter Examining Data
4300
4301 @cindex printing data
4302 @cindex examining data
4303 @kindex print
4304 @kindex inspect
4305 @c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4306 @c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4307 @c different window or something like that.
4308 The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
4309 command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4310 evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4311 program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4312 Different Languages}).
4313
4314 @table @code
4315 @item print @var{expr}
4316 @itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4317 @var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4318 value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
4319 you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
4320 @var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
4321 formats}.
4322
4323 @item print
4324 @itemx print /@var{f}
4325 If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
4326 @dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4327 conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4328 @end table
4329
4330 A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4331 It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4332 specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4333
4334 If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
4335 fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4336 command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
4337 Table}.
4338
4339 @menu
4340 * Expressions:: Expressions
4341 * Variables:: Program variables
4342 * Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4343 * Output Formats:: Output formats
4344 * Memory:: Examining memory
4345 * Auto Display:: Automatic display
4346 * Print Settings:: Print settings
4347 * Value History:: Value history
4348 * Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4349 * Registers:: Registers
4350 * Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
4351 * Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
4352 @end menu
4353
4354 @node Expressions
4355 @section Expressions
4356
4357 @cindex expressions
4358 @code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4359 compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4360 by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4361 @value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4362 and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4363 by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4364
4365 @value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4366 the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
4367 you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
4368 memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
4369
4370 Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4371 this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4372 Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4373 languages.
4374
4375 In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4376 expressions regardless of your programming language.
4377
4378 Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4379 useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4380 at that address in memory.
4381 @c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
4382
4383 @value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4384 to programming languages:
4385
4386 @table @code
4387 @item @@
4388 @samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4389 @xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4390
4391 @item ::
4392 @samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4393 function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4394
4395 @cindex @{@var{type}@}
4396 @cindex type casting memory
4397 @cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4398 @cindex casts, to view memory
4399 @item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4400 Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4401 memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4402 pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4403 a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4404 normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4405 @end table
4406
4407 @node Variables
4408 @section Program variables
4409
4410 The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4411 in your program.
4412
4413 Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4414 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4415
4416 @itemize @bullet
4417 @item
4418 global (or file-static)
4419 @end itemize
4420
4421 @noindent or
4422
4423 @itemize @bullet
4424 @item
4425 visible according to the scope rules of the
4426 programming language from the point of execution in that frame
4427 @end itemize
4428
4429 @noindent This means that in the function
4430
4431 @example
4432 foo (a)
4433 int a;
4434 @{
4435 bar (a);
4436 @{
4437 int b = test ();
4438 bar (b);
4439 @}
4440 @}
4441 @end example
4442
4443 @noindent
4444 you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4445 executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4446 examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4447 the block where @code{b} is declared.
4448
4449 @cindex variable name conflict
4450 There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4451 scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4452 in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4453 function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4454 happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4455 you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4456 using the colon-colon notation:
4457
4458 @cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
4459 @iftex
4460 @c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
4461 @cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
4462 @end iftex
4463 @example
4464 @var{file}::@var{variable}
4465 @var{function}::@var{variable}
4466 @end example
4467
4468 @noindent
4469 Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4470 static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4471 make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4472 to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4473
4474 @example
4475 (@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4476 @end example
4477
4478 @cindex C++ scope resolution
4479 This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
4480 use of the same notation in C++. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C++
4481 scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4482 @c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4483 @c conflict?? --mew
4484
4485 @cindex wrong values
4486 @cindex variable values, wrong
4487 @quotation
4488 @emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4489 wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4490 scope, and just before exit.
4491 @end quotation
4492 You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4493 This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4494 set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4495 stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4496 values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4497 also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4498 after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4499 variable definitions may be gone.
4500
4501 This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4502 To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4503 when compiling.
4504
4505 @cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4506 Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4507 unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4508 opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4509 offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4510 might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4511 happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4512
4513 @example
4514 No symbol "foo" in current context.
4515 @end example
4516
4517 To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4518 different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
4519 formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C++ compiler usually
4520 supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4521 in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
4522 to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
4523 debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4524 Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4525 information.
4526
4527
4528 @node Arrays
4529 @section Artificial arrays
4530
4531 @cindex artificial array
4532 @kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
4533 It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4534 same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4535 dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4536 program.
4537
4538 You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4539 @dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4540 operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4541 and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4542 of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4543 the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4544 argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4545 following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4546 example. If a program says
4547
4548 @example
4549 int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4550 @end example
4551
4552 @noindent
4553 you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4554
4555 @example
4556 p *array@@len
4557 @end example
4558
4559 The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4560 with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4561 subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4562 Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4563 (@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4564
4565 Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4566 This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4567 The value need not be in memory:
4568 @example
4569 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4570 $1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4571 @end example
4572
4573 As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
4574 @samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
4575 the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4576 @example
4577 (@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4578 $2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4579 @end example
4580
4581 Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4582 moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4583 actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4584 of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4585 to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4586 variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4587 interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4588 instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4589 structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4590 in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4591
4592 @example
4593 set $i = 0
4594 p dtab[$i++]->fv
4595 @key{RET}
4596 @key{RET}
4597 @dots{}
4598 @end example
4599
4600 @node Output Formats
4601 @section Output formats
4602
4603 @cindex formatted output
4604 @cindex output formats
4605 By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4606 this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4607 in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4608 at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4609 these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4610
4611 The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4612 already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4613 @code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4614 letters supported are:
4615
4616 @table @code
4617 @item x
4618 Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4619 hexadecimal.
4620
4621 @item d
4622 Print as integer in signed decimal.
4623
4624 @item u
4625 Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4626
4627 @item o
4628 Print as integer in octal.
4629
4630 @item t
4631 Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4632 @footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4633 used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
4634 see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
4635
4636 @item a
4637 @cindex unknown address, locating
4638 Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4639 the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4640 where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4641
4642 @example
4643 (@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4644 $3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4645 @end example
4646
4647 @item c
4648 Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4649
4650 @item f
4651 Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4652 using typical floating point syntax.
4653 @end table
4654
4655 For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4656
4657 @example
4658 p/x $pc
4659 @end example
4660
4661 @noindent
4662 Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4663 names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4664
4665 To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4666 you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4667 expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4668
4669 @node Memory
4670 @section Examining memory
4671
4672 You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4673 any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4674
4675 @cindex examining memory
4676 @table @code
4677 @kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
4678 @item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4679 @itemx x @var{addr}
4680 @itemx x
4681 Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4682 @end table
4683
4684 @var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4685 much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4686 expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4687 If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4688 Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4689
4690 @table @r
4691 @item @var{n}, the repeat count
4692 The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4693 how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4694 @c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4695 @c 4.1.2.
4696
4697 @item @var{f}, the display format
4698 The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4699 @samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4700 The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4701 The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4702
4703 @item @var{u}, the unit size
4704 The unit size is any of
4705
4706 @table @code
4707 @item b
4708 Bytes.
4709 @item h
4710 Halfwords (two bytes).
4711 @item w
4712 Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4713 @item g
4714 Giant words (eight bytes).
4715 @end table
4716
4717 Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4718 default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4719 @samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4720
4721 @item @var{addr}, starting display address
4722 @var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4723 memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4724 it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4725 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4726 @var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4727 other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4728 the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4729 starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4730 a value from memory).
4731 @end table
4732
4733 For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4734 (@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4735 starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4736 words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
4737 @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
4738
4739 Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4740 letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4741 unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4742 specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4743 (However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4744
4745 Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4746 and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4747 @samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4748 including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
4749 alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
4750 Code,,Source and machine code}.
4751
4752 All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4753 easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4754 you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4755 instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4756 with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4757 the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4758 for successive uses of @code{x}.
4759
4760 @cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4761 The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4762 in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4763 would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4764 subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4765 @code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4766 examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4767 @code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4768 the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4769
4770 If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4771 are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4772 address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4773
4774 @node Auto Display
4775 @section Automatic display
4776 @cindex automatic display
4777 @cindex display of expressions
4778
4779 If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4780 (to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4781 display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4782 Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4783 to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4784 The automatic display looks like this:
4785
4786 @example
4787 2: foo = 38
4788 3: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4789 @end example
4790
4791 @noindent
4792 This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4793 displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4794 specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4795 whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4796 format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4797 or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4798 supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4799
4800 @table @code
4801 @kindex display
4802 @item display @var{expr}
4803 Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
4804 each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4805
4806 @code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4807
4808 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
4809 For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
4810 count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
4811 arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4812 @xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4813
4814 @item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4815 For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4816 number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4817 be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4818 doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4819 @end table
4820
4821 For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4822 instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
4823 is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
4824
4825 @table @code
4826 @kindex delete display
4827 @kindex undisplay
4828 @item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4829 @itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4830 Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4831
4832 @code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4833 (Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4834
4835 @kindex disable display
4836 @item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4837 Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4838 item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4839 enabled again later.
4840
4841 @kindex enable display
4842 @item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4843 Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4844 again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4845
4846 @item display
4847 Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4848 done when your program stops.
4849
4850 @kindex info display
4851 @item info display
4852 Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4853 automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4854 values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4855 It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4856 because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4857 @end table
4858
4859 If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4860 sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4861 expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4862 variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4863 @code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4864 @code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4865 continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4866 there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4867 automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4868 is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4869
4870 @node Print Settings
4871 @section Print settings
4872
4873 @cindex format options
4874 @cindex print settings
4875 @value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4876 and symbols are printed.
4877
4878 @noindent
4879 These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4880
4881 @table @code
4882 @kindex set print address
4883 @item set print address
4884 @itemx set print address on
4885 @value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4886 traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4887 even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4888 is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4889 @code{set print address on}:
4890
4891 @smallexample
4892 @group
4893 (@value{GDBP}) f
4894 #0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4895 at input.c:530
4896 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4897 @end group
4898 @end smallexample
4899
4900 @item set print address off
4901 Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4902 this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4903
4904 @smallexample
4905 @group
4906 (@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4907 (@value{GDBP}) f
4908 #0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4909 530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4910 @end group
4911 @end smallexample
4912
4913 You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4914 dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4915 @code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4916 all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4917
4918 @kindex show print address
4919 @item show print address
4920 Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4921 @end table
4922
4923 When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4924 closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4925 identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4926 source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4927 @code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4928 you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4929 it prints a symbolic address:
4930
4931 @table @code
4932 @kindex set print symbol-filename
4933 @item set print symbol-filename on
4934 Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4935 symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4936
4937 @item set print symbol-filename off
4938 Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4939 default.
4940
4941 @kindex show print symbol-filename
4942 @item show print symbol-filename
4943 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
4944 line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4945 @end table
4946
4947 Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
4948 numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
4949 number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
4950
4951 Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
4952 printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
4953
4954 @table @code
4955 @kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
4956 @item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
4957 Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
4958 offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
4959 @var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
4960 to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
4961
4962 @kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
4963 @item show print max-symbolic-offset
4964 Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
4965 symbolic address.
4966 @end table
4967
4968 @cindex wild pointer, interpreting
4969 @cindex pointer, finding referent
4970 If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
4971 @samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
4972 and source file location of the variable where it points, using
4973 @samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
4974 For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
4975 at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
4976
4977 @example
4978 (@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
4979 (@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
4980 $4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
4981 @end example
4982
4983 @quotation
4984 @emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
4985 does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
4986 the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
4987 @end quotation
4988
4989 Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
4990
4991 @table @code
4992 @kindex set print array
4993 @item set print array
4994 @itemx set print array on
4995 Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
4996 but uses more space. The default is off.
4997
4998 @item set print array off
4999 Return to compressed format for arrays.
5000
5001 @kindex show print array
5002 @item show print array
5003 Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5004 arrays.
5005
5006 @kindex set print elements
5007 @item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5008 Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5009 If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5010 printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5011 This limit also applies to the display of strings.
5012 When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
5013 Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5014
5015 @kindex show print elements
5016 @item show print elements
5017 Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5018 If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5019
5020 @kindex set print null-stop
5021 @item set print null-stop
5022 Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
5023 @sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
5024 contain only short strings.
5025 The default is off.
5026
5027 @kindex set print pretty
5028 @item set print pretty on
5029 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
5030 per line, like this:
5031
5032 @smallexample
5033 @group
5034 $1 = @{
5035 next = 0x0,
5036 flags = @{
5037 sweet = 1,
5038 sour = 1
5039 @},
5040 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5041 @}
5042 @end group
5043 @end smallexample
5044
5045 @item set print pretty off
5046 Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5047
5048 @smallexample
5049 @group
5050 $1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5051 meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5052 @end group
5053 @end smallexample
5054
5055 @noindent
5056 This is the default format.
5057
5058 @kindex show print pretty
5059 @item show print pretty
5060 Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5061
5062 @kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5063 @item set print sevenbit-strings on
5064 Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5065 @value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5066 character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5067 best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5068 high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5069
5070 @item set print sevenbit-strings off
5071 Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5072 international character sets, and is the default.
5073
5074 @kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5075 @item show print sevenbit-strings
5076 Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5077
5078 @kindex set print union
5079 @item set print union on
5080 Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
5081 is the default setting.
5082
5083 @item set print union off
5084 Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5085
5086 @kindex show print union
5087 @item show print union
5088 Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5089 structures.
5090
5091 For example, given the declarations
5092
5093 @smallexample
5094 typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5095 typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5096 typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
5097 Bug_forms;
5098
5099 struct thing @{
5100 Species it;
5101 union @{
5102 Tree_forms tree;
5103 Bug_forms bug;
5104 @} form;
5105 @};
5106
5107 struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5108 @end smallexample
5109
5110 @noindent
5111 with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5112
5113 @smallexample
5114 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5115 @end smallexample
5116
5117 @noindent
5118 and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5119
5120 @smallexample
5121 $1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5122 @end smallexample
5123 @end table
5124
5125 @need 1000
5126 @noindent
5127 These settings are of interest when debugging C++ programs:
5128
5129 @table @code
5130 @cindex demangling
5131 @kindex set print demangle
5132 @item set print demangle
5133 @itemx set print demangle on
5134 Print C++ names in their source form rather than in the encoded
5135 (``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
5136 linkage. The default is on.
5137
5138 @kindex show print demangle
5139 @item show print demangle
5140 Show whether C++ names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
5141
5142 @kindex set print asm-demangle
5143 @item set print asm-demangle
5144 @itemx set print asm-demangle on
5145 Print C++ names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
5146 in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5147 The default is off.
5148
5149 @kindex show print asm-demangle
5150 @item show print asm-demangle
5151 Show whether C++ names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
5152 or demangled form.
5153
5154 @kindex set demangle-style
5155 @cindex C++ symbol decoding style
5156 @cindex symbol decoding style, C++
5157 @item set demangle-style @var{style}
5158 Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
5159 represent C++ names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
5160
5161 @table @code
5162 @item auto
5163 Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5164
5165 @item gnu
5166 Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C++ compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
5167 This is the default.
5168
5169 @item hp
5170 Decode based on the HP ANSI C++ (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
5171
5172 @item lucid
5173 Decode based on the Lucid C++ compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
5174
5175 @item arm
5176 Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C++ Annotated Reference Manual}.
5177 @strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5178 debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5179 require further enhancement to permit that.
5180
5181 @end table
5182 If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5183
5184 @kindex show demangle-style
5185 @item show demangle-style
5186 Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C++ symbols.
5187
5188 @kindex set print object
5189 @item set print object
5190 @itemx set print object on
5191 When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5192 (derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5193 the virtual function table.
5194
5195 @item set print object off
5196 Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5197 virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5198
5199 @kindex show print object
5200 @item show print object
5201 Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5202
5203 @kindex set print static-members
5204 @item set print static-members
5205 @itemx set print static-members on
5206 Print static members when displaying a C++ object. The default is on.
5207
5208 @item set print static-members off
5209 Do not print static members when displaying a C++ object.
5210
5211 @kindex show print static-members
5212 @item show print static-members
5213 Show whether C++ static members are printed, or not.
5214
5215 @c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5216 @kindex set print vtbl
5217 @item set print vtbl
5218 @itemx set print vtbl on
5219 Pretty print C++ virtual function tables. The default is off.
5220 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
5221 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
5222
5223 @item set print vtbl off
5224 Do not pretty print C++ virtual function tables.
5225
5226 @kindex show print vtbl
5227 @item show print vtbl
5228 Show whether C++ virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
5229 @end table
5230
5231 @node Value History
5232 @section Value history
5233
5234 @cindex value history
5235 Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5236 @dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5237 Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5238 (for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5239 When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5240 since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
5241 symbol table.
5242
5243 @cindex @code{$}
5244 @cindex @code{$$}
5245 @cindex history number
5246 The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5247 refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5248 @code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5249 printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5250 history number.
5251
5252 To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5253 history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5254 remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5255 the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5256 @code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5257 is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5258 @code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5259
5260 For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5261 want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5262
5263 @example
5264 p *$
5265 @end example
5266
5267 If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5268 to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5269
5270 @example
5271 p *$.next
5272 @end example
5273
5274 @noindent
5275 You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5276 command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5277
5278 Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5279 @code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5280
5281 @example
5282 print x
5283 set x=5
5284 @end example
5285
5286 @noindent
5287 then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5288 remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5289
5290 @table @code
5291 @kindex show values
5292 @item show values
5293 Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5294 This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5295 values} does not change the history.
5296
5297 @item show values @var{n}
5298 Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5299
5300 @item show values +
5301 Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5302 values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5303 @end table
5304
5305 Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5306 same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5307
5308 @node Convenience Vars
5309 @section Convenience variables
5310
5311 @cindex convenience variables
5312 @value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5313 @value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5314 exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5315 setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5316 of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5317
5318 Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5319 @samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
5320 the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
5321 (Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5322 by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5323
5324 You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5325 expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5326 For example:
5327
5328 @example
5329 set $foo = *object_ptr
5330 @end example
5331
5332 @noindent
5333 would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5334 @code{object_ptr}.
5335
5336 Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5337 value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5338 value with another assignment at any time.
5339
5340 Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5341 variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5342 that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5343 variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5344
5345 @table @code
5346 @kindex show convenience
5347 @item show convenience
5348 Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
5349 Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
5350 @end table
5351
5352 One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5353 incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5354 a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5355
5356 @example
5357 set $i = 0
5358 print bar[$i++]->contents
5359 @end example
5360
5361 @noindent
5362 Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
5363
5364 Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5365 values likely to be useful.
5366
5367 @table @code
5368 @vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
5369 @item $_
5370 The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5371 the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5372 commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5373 set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5374 and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5375 except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5376 to the type of @code{$__}.
5377
5378 @vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
5379 @item $__
5380 The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5381 to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5382 to match the format in which the data was printed.
5383
5384 @item $_exitcode
5385 @vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
5386 The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5387 the program being debugged terminates.
5388 @end table
5389
5390 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5391 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5392 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
5393
5394 @node Registers
5395 @section Registers
5396
5397 @cindex registers
5398 You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5399 with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5400 for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5401 your machine.
5402
5403 @table @code
5404 @kindex info registers
5405 @item info registers
5406 Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5407 registers (in the selected stack frame).
5408
5409 @kindex info all-registers
5410 @cindex floating point registers
5411 @item info all-registers
5412 Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5413 registers.
5414
5415 @item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5416 Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5417 As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5418 the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
5419 the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5420 @end table
5421
5422 @value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5423 expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5424 architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5425 @code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5426 the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5427 pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5428 register that contains the processor status. For example,
5429 you could print the program counter in hex with
5430
5431 @example
5432 p/x $pc
5433 @end example
5434
5435 @noindent
5436 or print the instruction to be executed next with
5437
5438 @example
5439 x/i $pc
5440 @end example
5441
5442 @noindent
5443 or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5444 one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5445 memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5446 stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5447 stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5448 regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
5449 see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
5450
5451 @example
5452 set $sp += 4
5453 @end example
5454
5455 Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5456 your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5457 so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5458 shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5459 registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
5460 can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5461 is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
5462
5463 @value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5464 integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5465 special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5466 registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5467 to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5468 (although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5469 @samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5470
5471 Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5472 means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5473 the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5474 sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5475 coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5476 programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5477 cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
5478 that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5479 prints the data in both formats.
5480
5481 Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5482 (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5483 value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5484 were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5485 true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5486 frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5487
5488 However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5489 code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5490 @value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5491 frame makes no difference.
5492
5493 @node Floating Point Hardware
5494 @section Floating point hardware
5495 @cindex floating point
5496
5497 Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5498 you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5499
5500 @table @code
5501 @kindex info float
5502 @item info float
5503 Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5504 point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5505 floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5506 the ARM and x86 machines.
5507 @end table
5508
5509 @node Memory Region Attributes
5510 @section Memory Region Attributes
5511 @cindex memory region attributes
5512
5513 @dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5514 required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5515 to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5516 use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5517
5518 Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5519 memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5520 accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5521 been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5522 all memory.
5523
5524 When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5525 to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5526
5527 @table @code
5528 @kindex mem
5529 @item mem @var{address1} @var{address1} @var{attributes}@dots{}
5530 Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5531 with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5532
5533 @kindex delete mem
5534 @item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5535 Remove memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5536
5537 @kindex disable mem
5538 @item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5539 Disable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5540 A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5541 It may be enabled again later.
5542
5543 @kindex enable mem
5544 @item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
5545 Enable memory region numbers @var{nums}.
5546
5547 @kindex info mem
5548 @item info mem
5549 Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5550 for each region.
5551
5552 @table @emph
5553 @item Memory Region Number
5554 @item Enabled or Disabled.
5555 Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5556 Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5557
5558 @item Lo Address
5559 The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5560
5561 @item Hi Address
5562 The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5563
5564 @item Attributes
5565 The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5566 @end table
5567 @end table
5568
5569
5570 @subsection Attributes
5571
5572 @subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5573 The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5574 write accesses to a memory region.
5575
5576 While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5577 memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5578 etc. from accessing memory.
5579
5580 @table @code
5581 @item ro
5582 Memory is read only.
5583 @item wo
5584 Memory is write only.
5585 @item rw
5586 Memory is read/write (default).
5587 @end table
5588
5589 @subsubsection Memory Access Size
5590 The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5591 accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5592 require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5593 specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5594
5595 @table @code
5596 @item 8
5597 Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5598 @item 16
5599 Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5600 @item 32
5601 Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5602 @item 64
5603 Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5604 @end table
5605
5606 @c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5607 @c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5608 @c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5609 @c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5610 @c
5611 @c @table @code
5612 @c @item hwbreak
5613 @c Always use hardware breakpoints
5614 @c @item swbreak (default)
5615 @c @end table
5616
5617 @subsubsection Data Cache
5618 The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5619 memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5620 protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5621 does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5622 registers.
5623
5624 @table @code
5625 @item cache
5626 Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5627 @item nocache (default)
5628 Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5629 @end table
5630
5631 @c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5632 @c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5633 @c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5634 @c
5635 @c @table @code
5636 @c @item verify
5637 @c @item noverify (default)
5638 @c @end table
5639
5640 @node Languages
5641 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
5642 @cindex languages
5643
5644 Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
5645 rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
5646 dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
5647 Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5648 represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
5649 @samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
5650
5651 @cindex working language
5652 Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
5653 allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
5654 native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
5655 consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
5656 language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
5657 language}.
5658
5659 @menu
5660 * Setting:: Switching between source languages
5661 * Show:: Displaying the language
5662 * Checks:: Type and range checks
5663 * Support:: Supported languages
5664 @end menu
5665
5666 @node Setting
5667 @section Switching between source languages
5668
5669 There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
5670 set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
5671 @code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
5672 defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
5673 used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
5674 are printed, etc.
5675
5676 In addition to the working language, every source file that
5677 @value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
5678 file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
5679 source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
5680 language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
5681 controls whether C++ names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
5682 show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
5683 set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
5684 set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
5685 Displaying the language}.
5686
5687 This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5688 as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
5689 another language. In that case, make the
5690 program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
5691 @value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
5692 program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
5693
5694 @menu
5695 * Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
5696 * Manually:: Setting the working language manually
5697 * Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5698 @end menu
5699
5700 @node Filenames
5701 @subsection List of filename extensions and languages
5702
5703 If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
5704 @value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
5705
5706 @table @file
5707
5708 @item .c
5709 C source file
5710
5711 @item .C
5712 @itemx .cc
5713 @itemx .cp
5714 @itemx .cpp
5715 @itemx .cxx
5716 @itemx .c++
5717 C++ source file
5718
5719 @item .f
5720 @itemx .F
5721 Fortran source file
5722
5723 @item .ch
5724 @itemx .c186
5725 @itemx .c286
5726 CHILL source file
5727
5728 @item .mod
5729 Modula-2 source file
5730
5731 @item .s
5732 @itemx .S
5733 Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
5734 @value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
5735 @end table
5736
5737 In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
5738 extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
5739
5740 @node Manually
5741 @subsection Setting the working language
5742
5743 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
5744 expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
5745 your program.
5746
5747 @kindex set language
5748 If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
5749 command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5750 a language, such as
5751 @code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
5752 For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
5753
5754 Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
5755 language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
5756 to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
5757 source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
5758 languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
5759 source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
5760 command such as:
5761
5762 @example
5763 print a = b + c
5764 @end example
5765
5766 @noindent
5767 might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
5768 @code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
5769 printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
5770 @code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
5771
5772 @node Automatically
5773 @subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
5774
5775 To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
5776 @samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
5777 then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
5778 frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
5779 working language to the language recorded for the function in that
5780 frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
5781 or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
5782 does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
5783 not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
5784
5785 This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
5786 entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
5787 written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
5788 a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
5789 case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
5790
5791 @node Show
5792 @section Displaying the language
5793
5794 The following commands help you find out which language is the
5795 working language, and also what language source files were written in.
5796
5797 @kindex show language
5798 @kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
5799 @kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
5800 @table @code
5801 @item show language
5802 Display the current working language. This is the
5803 language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
5804 build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
5805
5806 @item info frame
5807 Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
5808 working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5809 @xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
5810 information listed here.
5811
5812 @item info source
5813 Display the source language of this source file.
5814 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
5815 information listed here.
5816 @end table
5817
5818 In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
5819 not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
5820 with a language explicitly:
5821
5822 @kindex set extension-language
5823 @kindex info extensions
5824 @table @code
5825 @item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
5826 Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
5827 the source language @var{language}.
5828
5829 @item info extensions
5830 List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
5831 @end table
5832
5833 @node Checks
5834 @section Type and range checking
5835
5836 @quotation
5837 @emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
5838 checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
5839 section documents the intended facilities.
5840 @end quotation
5841 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
5842
5843 Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
5844 errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
5845 checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
5846 sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
5847 these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
5848 by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
5849 errors when your program is running.
5850
5851 @value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
5852 Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
5853 can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
5854 the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
5855 @value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
5856 your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
5857 for the default settings of supported languages.
5858
5859 @menu
5860 * Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
5861 * Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
5862 @end menu
5863
5864 @cindex type checking
5865 @cindex checks, type
5866 @node Type Checking
5867 @subsection An overview of type checking
5868
5869 Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
5870 arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
5871 otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
5872 errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
5873
5874 @smallexample
5875 1 + 2 @result{} 3
5876 @exdent but
5877 @error{} 1 + 2.3
5878 @end smallexample
5879
5880 The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
5881 type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
5882
5883 For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
5884 @value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
5885 to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
5886 or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
5887 but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
5888 these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
5889 also issues a warning.
5890
5891 Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
5892 related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
5893 For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
5894 a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
5895 with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
5896 the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
5897
5898 Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
5899 instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
5900 operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
5901 represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
5902 operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
5903 details on specific languages.
5904
5905 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
5906
5907 @kindex set check@r{, type}
5908 @kindex set check type
5909 @kindex show check type
5910 @table @code
5911 @item set check type auto
5912 Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
5913 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5914 each language.
5915
5916 @item set check type on
5917 @itemx set check type off
5918 Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5919 current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
5920 match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
5921 evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
5922 message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
5923
5924 @item set check type warn
5925 Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
5926 evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
5927 be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
5928 numbers and structures.
5929
5930 @item show type
5931 Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
5932 is setting it automatically.
5933 @end table
5934
5935 @cindex range checking
5936 @cindex checks, range
5937 @node Range Checking
5938 @subsection An overview of range checking
5939
5940 In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
5941 bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
5942 checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
5943 computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
5944 not exceed the bounds of the array.
5945
5946 For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
5947 @value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
5948 always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
5949 warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
5950
5951 A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
5952 array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
5953 of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
5954 error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
5955 result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
5956 the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
5957
5958 @example
5959 @var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
5960 @end example
5961
5962 This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
5963 specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
5964 Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
5965
5966 @value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
5967
5968 @kindex set check@r{, range}
5969 @kindex set check range
5970 @kindex show check range
5971 @table @code
5972 @item set check range auto
5973 Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
5974 @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
5975 each language.
5976
5977 @item set check range on
5978 @itemx set check range off
5979 Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
5980 current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
5981 match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
5982 then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
5983
5984 @item set check range warn
5985 Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
5986 but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
5987 expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
5988 memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
5989 systems).
5990
5991 @item show range
5992 Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
5993 being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
5994 @end table
5995
5996 @node Support
5997 @section Supported languages
5998
5999 @value{GDBN} supports C, C++, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
6000 @c This is false ...
6001 Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
6002 language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
6003 and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
6004 ,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
6005 language.
6006
6007 The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
6008 supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
6009 tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
6010 @value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
6011 formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
6012 books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
6013 language reference or tutorial.
6014
6015 @menu
6016 * C:: C and C++
6017 * Modula-2:: Modula-2
6018 * Chill:: Chill
6019 @end menu
6020
6021 @node C
6022 @subsection C and C++
6023
6024 @cindex C and C++
6025 @cindex expressions in C or C++
6026
6027 Since C and C++ are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
6028 to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
6029 together.
6030
6031 @cindex C@t{++}
6032 @cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
6033 @cindex @sc{gnu} C++
6034 The C++ debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C++
6035 compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C++ code
6036 effectively, you must compile your C++ programs with a supported
6037 C++ compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C++
6038 compiler (@code{aCC}).
6039
6040 For best results when using @sc{gnu} C++, use the stabs debugging
6041 format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
6042 command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
6043 @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
6044 CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
6045
6046 @menu
6047 * C Operators:: C and C++ operators
6048 * C Constants:: C and C++ constants
6049 * C plus plus expressions:: C++ expressions
6050 * C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C++
6051 * C Checks:: C and C++ type and range checks
6052 * Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
6053 * Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C++
6054 @end menu
6055
6056 @node C Operators
6057 @subsubsection C and C++ operators
6058
6059 @cindex C and C++ operators
6060
6061 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6062 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6063 often defined on groups of types.
6064
6065 For the purposes of C and C++, the following definitions hold:
6066
6067 @itemize @bullet
6068
6069 @item
6070 @emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
6071 specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C++, @code{bool}.
6072
6073 @item
6074 @emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
6075 @code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
6076
6077 @item
6078 @emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
6079
6080 @item
6081 @emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
6082
6083 @end itemize
6084
6085 @noindent
6086 The following operators are supported. They are listed here
6087 in order of increasing precedence:
6088
6089 @table @code
6090 @item ,
6091 The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
6092 are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
6093 expression being the last expression evaluated.
6094
6095 @item =
6096 Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
6097 assigned. Defined on scalar types.
6098
6099 @item @var{op}=
6100 Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
6101 and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
6102 @w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
6103 @var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
6104 @code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
6105
6106 @item ?:
6107 The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
6108 of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
6109 integral type.
6110
6111 @item ||
6112 Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6113
6114 @item &&
6115 Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6116
6117 @item |
6118 Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6119
6120 @item ^
6121 Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
6122
6123 @item &
6124 Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
6125
6126 @item ==@r{, }!=
6127 Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
6128 expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
6129
6130 @item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
6131 Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
6132 Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
6133 and non-zero for true.
6134
6135 @item <<@r{, }>>
6136 left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
6137
6138 @item @@
6139 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6140
6141 @item +@r{, }-
6142 Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
6143 pointer types.
6144
6145 @item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
6146 Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
6147 defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
6148 integral types.
6149
6150 @item ++@r{, }--
6151 Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
6152 operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
6153 when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
6154 operation takes place.
6155
6156 @item *
6157 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
6158 @code{++}.
6159
6160 @item &
6161 Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
6162
6163 For debugging C++, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
6164 allowed in the C++ language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
6165 (or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
6166 where a C++ reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
6167 stored.
6168
6169 @item -
6170 Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
6171 precedence as @code{++}.
6172
6173 @item !
6174 Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6175 @code{++}.
6176
6177 @item ~
6178 Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
6179 @code{++}.
6180
6181
6182 @item .@r{, }->
6183 Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
6184 @value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
6185 pointer based on the stored type information.
6186 Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
6187
6188 @item .*@r{, }->*
6189 Dereferences of pointers to members.
6190
6191 @item []
6192 Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
6193 @code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6194
6195 @item ()
6196 Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
6197
6198 @item ::
6199 C++ scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
6200 and @code{class} types.
6201
6202 @item ::
6203 Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
6204 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
6205 above.
6206 @end table
6207
6208 If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
6209 attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
6210 predefined meaning.
6211
6212 @menu
6213 * C Constants::
6214 @end menu
6215
6216 @node C Constants
6217 @subsubsection C and C++ constants
6218
6219 @cindex C and C++ constants
6220
6221 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C++ in the
6222 following ways:
6223
6224 @itemize @bullet
6225 @item
6226 Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
6227 specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
6228 a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
6229 @samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
6230 @code{long} value.
6231
6232 @item
6233 Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
6234 point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
6235 exponent. An exponent is of the form:
6236 @samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
6237 sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
6238 A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
6239 @samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
6240 the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
6241 a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
6242 constant.
6243
6244 @item
6245 Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
6246 integral equivalents.
6247
6248 @item
6249 Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
6250 (@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
6251 (usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
6252 be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
6253 the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
6254 of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
6255 @samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
6256 @samp{\n} for newline.
6257
6258 @item
6259 String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
6260 double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
6261 above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
6262 a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
6263 characters.
6264
6265 @item
6266 Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
6267 to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
6268
6269 @item
6270 Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
6271 and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
6272 integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
6273 and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
6274 @end itemize
6275
6276 @menu
6277 * C plus plus expressions::
6278 * C Defaults::
6279 * C Checks::
6280
6281 * Debugging C::
6282 @end menu
6283
6284 @node C plus plus expressions
6285 @subsubsection C++ expressions
6286
6287 @cindex expressions in C++
6288 @value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C++ expressions.
6289
6290 @cindex C++ support, not in @sc{coff}
6291 @cindex @sc{coff} versus C++
6292 @cindex C++ and object formats
6293 @cindex object formats and C++
6294 @cindex a.out and C++
6295 @cindex @sc{ecoff} and C++
6296 @cindex @sc{xcoff} and C++
6297 @cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C++
6298 @cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C++
6299 @c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
6300 @c periodically whether this has happened...
6301 @quotation
6302 @emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C++ code if you use the
6303 proper compiler. Typically, C++ debugging depends on the use of
6304 additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
6305 special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
6306 @sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
6307 symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
6308 you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
6309 extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
6310 @sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C++
6311 support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
6312 @end quotation
6313
6314 @enumerate
6315
6316 @cindex member functions
6317 @item
6318 Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
6319
6320 @example
6321 count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
6322 @end example
6323
6324 @vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
6325 @cindex namespace in C++
6326 @item
6327 While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
6328 expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
6329 that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
6330 pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C++.
6331
6332 @cindex call overloaded functions
6333 @cindex overloaded functions, calling
6334 @cindex type conversions in C++
6335 @item
6336 You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
6337 call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
6338 perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
6339 calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
6340 in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
6341 default arguments.
6342
6343 It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
6344 promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
6345 class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
6346 functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
6347 number of function arguments.
6348
6349 Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
6350 @code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
6351 ,@value{GDBN} features for C++}.
6352
6353 You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
6354 explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
6355 @smallexample
6356 p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
6357 @end smallexample
6358
6359 The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
6360 see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
6361
6362 @cindex reference declarations
6363 @item
6364 @value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C++ references; you can use
6365 them in expressions just as you do in C++ source---they are automatically
6366 dereferenced.
6367
6368 In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
6369 reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
6370 avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
6371 The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
6372 you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
6373
6374 @item
6375 @value{GDBN} supports the C++ name resolution operator @code{::}---your
6376 expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
6377 one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
6378 necessary, for example in an expression like
6379 @samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
6380 resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C++
6381 debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
6382 @end enumerate
6383
6384 In addition, when used with HP's C++ compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
6385 calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
6386 objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
6387 invoking user-defined operators.
6388
6389 @node C Defaults
6390 @subsubsection C and C++ defaults
6391
6392 @cindex C and C++ defaults
6393
6394 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
6395 both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
6396 C or C++. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6397 selects the working language.
6398
6399 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
6400 recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
6401 @file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
6402 these files, it sets the working language to C or C++.
6403 @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
6404 for further details.
6405
6406 @c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
6407 @c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
6408 @c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
6409
6410 @node C Checks
6411 @subsubsection C and C++ type and range checks
6412
6413 @cindex C and C++ checks
6414
6415 By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C++ expressions, type checking
6416 is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
6417 considers two variables type equivalent if:
6418
6419 @itemize @bullet
6420 @item
6421 The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
6422 enumerated tag.
6423
6424 @item
6425 The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
6426 declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
6427
6428 @ignore
6429 @c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
6430 @c FIXME--beers?
6431 @item
6432 The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
6433 declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
6434 compilers.)
6435 @end ignore
6436 @end itemize
6437
6438 Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
6439 indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
6440 that is not itself an array.
6441
6442 @node Debugging C
6443 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
6444
6445 The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
6446 the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
6447 inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
6448 appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
6449
6450 The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
6451 with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
6452 ,Expressions}.
6453
6454 @menu
6455 * Debugging C plus plus::
6456 @end menu
6457
6458 @node Debugging C plus plus
6459 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C++
6460
6461 @cindex commands for C++
6462
6463 Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C++, and some are
6464 designed specifically for use with C++. Here is a summary:
6465
6466 @table @code
6467 @cindex break in overloaded functions
6468 @item @r{breakpoint menus}
6469 When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
6470 @value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
6471 you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
6472
6473 @cindex overloading in C++
6474 @item rbreak @var{regex}
6475 Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
6476 breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
6477 classes.
6478 @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
6479
6480 @cindex C++ exception handling
6481 @item catch throw
6482 @itemx catch catch
6483 Debug C++ exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
6484 Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
6485
6486 @cindex inheritance
6487 @item ptype @var{typename}
6488 Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
6489 @var{typename}.
6490 @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
6491
6492 @cindex C++ symbol display
6493 @item set print demangle
6494 @itemx show print demangle
6495 @itemx set print asm-demangle
6496 @itemx show print asm-demangle
6497 Control whether C++ symbols display in their source form, both when
6498 displaying code as C++ source and when displaying disassemblies.
6499 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6500
6501 @item set print object
6502 @itemx show print object
6503 Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
6504 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6505
6506 @item set print vtbl
6507 @itemx show print vtbl
6508 Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
6509 @xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
6510 (The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
6511 ANSI C++ compiler (@code{aCC}).)
6512
6513 @kindex set overload-resolution
6514 @cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
6515 @item set overload-resolution on
6516 Enable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. The default
6517 is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
6518 and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
6519 using the standard C++ conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C++
6520 expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
6521 message.
6522
6523 @item set overload-resolution off
6524 Disable overload resolution for C++ expression evaluation. For
6525 overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6526 chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
6527 symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
6528 overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
6529 searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
6530 argument types.
6531
6532 @item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
6533 You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
6534 the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C++: type
6535 @code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
6536 also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
6537 available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
6538 @xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
6539 @end table
6540
6541 @node Modula-2
6542 @subsection Modula-2
6543
6544 @cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
6545
6546 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
6547 output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
6548 developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
6549 attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
6550 to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6551 table.
6552
6553 @cindex expressions in Modula-2
6554 @menu
6555 * M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
6556 * Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
6557 * M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
6558 * M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
6559 * Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
6560 * M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
6561 * M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6562 * GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6563 @end menu
6564
6565 @node M2 Operators
6566 @subsubsection Operators
6567 @cindex Modula-2 operators
6568
6569 Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
6570 @code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
6571 often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
6572 following definitions hold:
6573
6574 @itemize @bullet
6575
6576 @item
6577 @emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
6578 their subranges.
6579
6580 @item
6581 @emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
6582
6583 @item
6584 @emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
6585
6586 @item
6587 @emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
6588 @var{type}}.
6589
6590 @item
6591 @emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
6592
6593 @item
6594 @emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
6595
6596 @item
6597 @emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
6598 @end itemize
6599
6600 @noindent
6601 The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
6602 increasing precedence:
6603
6604 @table @code
6605 @item ,
6606 Function argument or array index separator.
6607
6608 @item :=
6609 Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
6610 @var{value}.
6611
6612 @item <@r{, }>
6613 Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
6614 types.
6615
6616 @item <=@r{, }>=
6617 Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
6618 on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
6619 set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
6620
6621 @item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
6622 Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
6623 Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
6624 available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
6625 comment character.
6626
6627 @item IN
6628 Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
6629 Same precedence as @code{<}.
6630
6631 @item OR
6632 Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6633
6634 @item AND@r{, }&
6635 Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
6636
6637 @item @@
6638 The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
6639
6640 @item +@r{, }-
6641 Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
6642 and difference on set types.
6643
6644 @item *
6645 Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
6646 on set types.
6647
6648 @item /
6649 Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
6650 types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
6651
6652 @item DIV@r{, }MOD
6653 Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
6654 precedence as @code{*}.
6655
6656 @item -
6657 Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
6658
6659 @item ^
6660 Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
6661
6662 @item NOT
6663 Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
6664 @code{^}.
6665
6666 @item .
6667 @code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
6668 precedence as @code{^}.
6669
6670 @item []
6671 Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
6672
6673 @item ()
6674 Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
6675 as @code{^}.
6676
6677 @item ::@r{, }.
6678 @value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
6679 @end table
6680
6681 @quotation
6682 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
6683 treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
6684 @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
6685 @code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
6686 @end quotation
6687
6688 @cindex Modula-2 built-ins
6689 @node Built-In Func/Proc
6690 @subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
6691
6692 Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
6693 In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
6694
6695 @table @var
6696
6697 @item a
6698 represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
6699
6700 @item c
6701 represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
6702
6703 @item i
6704 represents a variable or constant of integral type.
6705
6706 @item m
6707 represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
6708 same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
6709 be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
6710
6711 @item n
6712 represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
6713
6714 @item r
6715 represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
6716
6717 @item t
6718 represents a type.
6719
6720 @item v
6721 represents a variable.
6722
6723 @item x
6724 represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
6725 explanation of the function for details.
6726 @end table
6727
6728 All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
6729
6730 @table @code
6731 @item ABS(@var{n})
6732 Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
6733
6734 @item CAP(@var{c})
6735 If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
6736 equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
6737
6738 @item CHR(@var{i})
6739 Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6740
6741 @item DEC(@var{v})
6742 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6743
6744 @item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
6745 Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6746 new value.
6747
6748 @item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6749 Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
6750 set.
6751
6752 @item FLOAT(@var{i})
6753 Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
6754
6755 @item HIGH(@var{a})
6756 Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
6757
6758 @item INC(@var{v})
6759 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
6760
6761 @item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
6762 Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
6763 new value.
6764
6765 @item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
6766 Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
6767 there. Returns the new set.
6768
6769 @item MAX(@var{t})
6770 Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
6771
6772 @item MIN(@var{t})
6773 Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
6774
6775 @item ODD(@var{i})
6776 Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
6777
6778 @item ORD(@var{x})
6779 Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
6780 value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
6781 @sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
6782 integral, character and enumerated types.
6783
6784 @item SIZE(@var{x})
6785 Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
6786
6787 @item TRUNC(@var{r})
6788 Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
6789
6790 @item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
6791 Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
6792 @end table
6793
6794 @quotation
6795 @emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
6796 @value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
6797 an error.
6798 @end quotation
6799
6800 @cindex Modula-2 constants
6801 @node M2 Constants
6802 @subsubsection Constants
6803
6804 @value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
6805 ways:
6806
6807 @itemize @bullet
6808
6809 @item
6810 Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
6811 expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
6812 rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
6813 trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
6814
6815 @item
6816 Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
6817 decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
6818 then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
6819 @samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
6820 digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
6821 digits.
6822
6823 @item
6824 Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
6825 like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
6826 also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
6827 followed by a @samp{C}.
6828
6829 @item
6830 String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
6831 pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
6832 Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
6833 Constants, ,C and C++ constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
6834 sequences.
6835
6836 @item
6837 Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
6838
6839 @item
6840 Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
6841 @code{FALSE}.
6842
6843 @item
6844 Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
6845
6846 @item
6847 Set constants are not yet supported.
6848 @end itemize
6849
6850 @node M2 Defaults
6851 @subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
6852 @cindex Modula-2 defaults
6853
6854 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
6855 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
6856 Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
6857 selected the working language.
6858
6859 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
6860 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
6861 working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
6862 the language automatically}, for further details.
6863
6864 @node Deviations
6865 @subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
6866 @cindex Modula-2, deviations from
6867
6868 A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
6869 This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
6870
6871 @itemize @bullet
6872 @item
6873 Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
6874 integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
6875 debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
6876 pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
6877 through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
6878 returned a pointer.)
6879
6880 @item
6881 C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
6882 non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
6883 escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
6884 printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
6885
6886 @item
6887 The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
6888 argument.
6889
6890 @item
6891 All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
6892 @end itemize
6893
6894 @node M2 Checks
6895 @subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
6896 @cindex Modula-2 checks
6897
6898 @quotation
6899 @emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
6900 range checking.
6901 @end quotation
6902 @c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
6903
6904 @value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
6905
6906 @itemize @bullet
6907 @item
6908 They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
6909 @var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
6910
6911 @item
6912 They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
6913 @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
6914 @end itemize
6915
6916 As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
6917 whose types are not equivalent is an error.
6918
6919 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
6920 index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
6921
6922 @node M2 Scope
6923 @subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
6924 @cindex scope
6925 @cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
6926 @cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
6927 @ifinfo
6928 @vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
6929 @c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
6930 @end ifinfo
6931 @iftex
6932 @vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
6933 @end iftex
6934
6935 There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
6936 (@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
6937 similar syntax:
6938
6939 @example
6940
6941 @var{module} . @var{id}
6942 @var{scope} :: @var{id}
6943 @end example
6944
6945 @noindent
6946 where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
6947 @var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
6948 identifier within your program, except another module.
6949
6950 Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
6951 specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
6952 found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
6953 enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
6954
6955 Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
6956 the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
6957 definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
6958 an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
6959 module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
6960 @var{module}.
6961
6962 @node GDB/M2
6963 @subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
6964
6965 Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
6966 Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
6967 specifically to C and C++: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
6968 @samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
6969 apply to C++, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
6970 analogue in Modula-2.
6971
6972 The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
6973 with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
6974 intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
6975 created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C++. However, because an
6976 address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
6977 @samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
6978
6979 @cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
6980 In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
6981 interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
6982
6983 @node Chill
6984 @subsection Chill
6985
6986 The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
6987 from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
6988 supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
6989 likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
6990 table.
6991
6992 @c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
6993 @c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
6994 This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
6995 of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
6996
6997 @menu
6998 * How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
6999 * Locations:: Locations and their accesses
7000 * Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
7001 * Chill type and range checks::
7002 * Chill defaults::
7003 @end menu
7004
7005 @node How modes are displayed
7006 @subsubsection How modes are displayed
7007
7008 The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
7009 with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
7010 slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
7011 provided modes are:
7012
7013 @c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
7014 @c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
7015 @table @code
7016 @item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
7017 @itemize @bullet
7018 @item
7019 @emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
7020 UINT, LONG, ULONG},
7021 @item
7022 @emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
7023 @item
7024 @emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
7025 @item
7026 @emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
7027 @smallexample
7028 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7029 type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7030 @end smallexample
7031 If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
7032 @item
7033 @emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
7034 @smallexample
7035 @code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
7036 @end smallexample
7037 where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
7038 expression (e.g. set element names).
7039 @end itemize
7040
7041 @item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
7042 A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
7043 the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
7044 @smallexample
7045 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7046 type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
7047 @end smallexample
7048
7049 @item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
7050 @itemize @bullet
7051 @item
7052 @emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
7053 followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
7054 @item
7055 @emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
7056 @end itemize
7057
7058 @item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
7059 The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
7060 <return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
7061 list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
7062 the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
7063 all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
7064
7065 @ignore
7066 @item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
7067 The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
7068 type, and is therefore not really of interest.
7069 @end ignore
7070
7071 @item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
7072 @itemize @bullet
7073 @item
7074 @emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
7075 @smallexample
7076 @code{EVENT (<event length>)}
7077 @end smallexample
7078 where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
7079 @item
7080 @emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
7081 @smallexample
7082 @code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
7083 @end smallexample
7084 where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
7085 @end itemize
7086
7087 @item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
7088 @itemize @bullet
7089 @item
7090 @emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
7091 @item
7092 @emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
7093 @end itemize
7094
7095 @item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
7096 Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
7097
7098 @item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
7099 @itemize @bullet
7100 @item
7101 @emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
7102 @smallexample
7103 @code{CHARS(<string length>)}
7104 @end smallexample
7105 followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
7106 mode
7107 @item
7108 @emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
7109 @smallexample
7110 @code{BOOLS(<string
7111 length>)}
7112 @end smallexample
7113 @end itemize
7114
7115 @item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
7116 The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
7117 followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
7118 @smallexample
7119 (@value{GDBP}) ptype x
7120 type = ARRAY (1:42)
7121 ARRAY (1:20)
7122 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
7123 @end smallexample
7124
7125 @item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
7126 The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
7127 list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
7128 of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
7129 OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
7130 of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
7131 checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
7132 always displays all variant fields.
7133 @smallexample
7134 (@value{GDBP}) ptype str
7135 type = STRUCT (
7136 as x,
7137 bs x,
7138 CASE bs OF
7139 (karli):
7140 cs a
7141 (ott):
7142 ds x
7143 ESAC
7144 )
7145 @end smallexample
7146 @end table
7147
7148 @node Locations
7149 @subsubsection Locations and their accesses
7150
7151 A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
7152
7153 A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
7154 the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
7155 Chill programs. How values are specified
7156 is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
7157
7158 The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
7159 display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
7160
7161 @smallexample
7162 set result := EXPR
7163 @end smallexample
7164
7165 @noindent
7166 This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
7167 is not available in @value{GDBN}).
7168
7169 Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
7170 value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
7171 mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
7172 represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
7173 value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
7174 operator @samp{->}.
7175
7176 Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
7177 @smallexample
7178 @code{@{ PROC
7179 (<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
7180 location>}
7181 @end smallexample
7182 @code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
7183 specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
7184 the entry point.
7185
7186 @ignore
7187 Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
7188 fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
7189 the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
7190 implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
7191 na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
7192 <instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
7193 @code{__proc_copy}.
7194
7195 Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
7196 the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
7197 like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
7198 mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
7199
7200 Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
7201 ...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
7202 definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
7203 of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
7204 structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
7205 braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
7206 on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
7207 memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
7208 all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
7209 @code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
7210 stuff ???)
7211 @smallexample
7212 (@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
7213 [.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
7214 @end smallexample
7215 @end ignore
7216
7217 Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
7218 (e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
7219 certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
7220 and their Operations}.
7221
7222 A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
7223 location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
7224 name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
7225 have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
7226 checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
7227 therefore the result can be quite confusing.
7228
7229 @smallexample
7230 (@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
7231 @end smallexample
7232
7233 @node Values and their Operations
7234 @subsubsection Values and their Operations
7235
7236 Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
7237 more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
7238 data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
7239 such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
7240 constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
7241 when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
7242 (e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
7243 the values behind these locations.
7244
7245 This section describes how values have to be specified and which
7246 operations are legal to be used with such values.
7247
7248 @table @code
7249 @item Literal Values
7250 Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
7251 For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
7252 chapter 1.5.
7253 @c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
7254 @c be converted to a @ref.
7255
7256 @ignore
7257 @itemize @bullet
7258 @item
7259 @emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7260 programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
7261 @item
7262 @emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
7263 @item
7264 @emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
7265 @code{'M'})
7266 @item
7267 @emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
7268 mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
7269 comparable to an enumeration in C/C++ language.
7270 @item
7271 @emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
7272 emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
7273 procedure value or the empty instance value.
7274
7275 @item
7276 @emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
7277 enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
7278 to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
7279 @item
7280 @emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
7281 programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
7282 @item
7283 @emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
7284 (gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
7285 @end itemize
7286 @end ignore
7287
7288 @item Tuple Values
7289 A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
7290 name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
7291 unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
7292 @code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
7293
7294 @itemize @bullet
7295 @item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
7296 @item @emph{Array Tuple}
7297 @item @emph{Structure Tuple}
7298 Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
7299 same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
7300 @end itemize
7301
7302 @item String Element Value
7303 A string element value is specified by
7304 @smallexample
7305 @code{<string value>(<index>)}
7306 @end smallexample
7307 where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
7308 value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
7309 the string.
7310
7311 @item String Slice Value
7312 A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
7313 spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
7314 expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
7315 @code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
7316 The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
7317 string.
7318
7319 @item Array Element Values
7320 An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
7321 delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
7322
7323 @item Array Slice Values
7324 An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
7325 @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
7326 @code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
7327 arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
7328 which is part of the specified array.
7329
7330 @item Structure Field Values
7331 A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
7332 name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
7333 in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
7334 corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
7335
7336 @item Procedure Call Value
7337 The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
7338 procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
7339 expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
7340 effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
7341
7342 Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
7343
7344 Values of time mode locations appear as
7345 @smallexample
7346 @code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
7347 @end smallexample
7348
7349
7350 @ignore
7351 This is not implemented yet:
7352 @item Built-in Value
7353 @noindent
7354 The following built in functions are provided:
7355
7356 @table @code
7357 @item @code{ADDR()}
7358 @item @code{NUM()}
7359 @item @code{PRED()}
7360 @item @code{SUCC()}
7361 @item @code{ABS()}
7362 @item @code{CARD()}
7363 @item @code{MAX()}
7364 @item @code{MIN()}
7365 @item @code{SIZE()}
7366 @item @code{UPPER()}
7367 @item @code{LOWER()}
7368 @item @code{LENGTH()}
7369 @item @code{SIN()}
7370 @item @code{COS()}
7371 @item @code{TAN()}
7372 @item @code{ARCSIN()}
7373 @item @code{ARCCOS()}
7374 @item @code{ARCTAN()}
7375 @item @code{EXP()}
7376 @item @code{LN()}
7377 @item @code{LOG()}
7378 @item @code{SQRT()}
7379 @end table
7380
7381 For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
7382 chapter 1.6.
7383 @end ignore
7384
7385 @item Zero-adic Operator Value
7386 The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
7387 current active process.
7388
7389 @item Expression Values
7390 The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
7391 the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
7392 incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
7393 corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
7394 causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
7395 which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
7396 operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
7397
7398 @table @code
7399 @item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
7400 @itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
7401 @itemx @code{NOT}
7402 Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
7403
7404 @item @code{=, /=}
7405 Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
7406
7407 @item @code{>, >=}
7408 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7409 Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
7410
7411 @item @code{+, -}
7412 @itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
7413 Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
7414
7415 @item @code{-}
7416 Change sign operator.
7417
7418 @item @code{//}
7419 String concatenation operator.
7420
7421 @item @code{()}
7422 String repetition operator.
7423
7424 @item @code{->}
7425 Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
7426 address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
7427 location (@code{loc->}).
7428
7429 @item @code{OR, XOR}
7430 @itemx @code{AND}
7431 @itemx @code{NOT}
7432 Powerset and bitstring operators.
7433
7434 @item @code{>, >=}
7435 @itemx @code{<, <=}
7436 Powerset inclusion operators.
7437
7438 @item @code{IN}
7439 Membership operator.
7440 @end table
7441 @end table
7442
7443 @node Chill type and range checks
7444 @subsubsection Chill type and range checks
7445
7446 @value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
7447 of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
7448 complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
7449 equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
7450 structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
7451
7452 Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7453 index bounds and all built in procedures.
7454
7455 Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
7456 check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
7457 operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
7458 functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
7459 language specification.
7460
7461 All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
7462 off}.
7463
7464 @ignore
7465 @c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
7466 see last paragraph ?
7467 @end ignore
7468
7469 @node Chill defaults
7470 @subsubsection Chill defaults
7471
7472 If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7473 both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
7474 Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
7475 selected the working language.
7476
7477 If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7478 code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
7479 working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
7480 the language automatically}, for further details.
7481
7482 @node Symbols
7483 @chapter Examining the Symbol Table
7484
7485 The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
7486 symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
7487 program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
7488 does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
7489 program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
7490 (@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
7491 file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
7492
7493 @cindex symbol names
7494 @cindex names of symbols
7495 @cindex quoting names
7496 Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
7497 characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
7498 most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
7499 source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
7500 are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
7501 ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
7502 @samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
7503 @samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
7504
7505 @example
7506 p 'foo.c'::x
7507 @end example
7508
7509 @noindent
7510 looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
7511
7512 @table @code
7513 @kindex info address
7514 @item info address @var{symbol}
7515 Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
7516 variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
7517 local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
7518 is always stored.
7519
7520 Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
7521 at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
7522 the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
7523
7524 @kindex whatis
7525 @item whatis @var{expr}
7526 Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
7527 actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
7528 assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
7529 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
7530
7531 @item whatis
7532 Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7533
7534 @kindex ptype
7535 @item ptype @var{typename}
7536 Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7537 the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
7538 @var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
7539 @var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
7540
7541 @item ptype @var{expr}
7542 @itemx ptype
7543 Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
7544 differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
7545 of just the name of the type.
7546
7547 For example, for this variable declaration:
7548
7549 @example
7550 struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
7551 @end example
7552
7553 @noindent
7554 the two commands give this output:
7555
7556 @example
7557 @group
7558 (@value{GDBP}) whatis v
7559 type = struct complex
7560 (@value{GDBP}) ptype v
7561 type = struct complex @{
7562 double real;
7563 double imag;
7564 @}
7565 @end group
7566 @end example
7567
7568 @noindent
7569 As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
7570 the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
7571
7572 @kindex info types
7573 @item info types @var{regexp}
7574 @itemx info types
7575 Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
7576 (or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
7577 complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
7578 @samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
7579 names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
7580 information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
7581
7582 This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
7583 @code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
7584 lists all source files where a type is defined.
7585
7586 @kindex info source
7587 @item info source
7588 Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
7589 the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
7590 it was written in.
7591
7592 @kindex info sources
7593 @item info sources
7594 Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
7595 debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
7596 have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
7597
7598 @kindex info functions
7599 @item info functions
7600 Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
7601
7602 @item info functions @var{regexp}
7603 Print the names and data types of all defined functions
7604 whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
7605 Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
7606 include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
7607 start with @code{step}.
7608
7609 @kindex info variables
7610 @item info variables
7611 Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
7612 outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
7613
7614 @item info variables @var{regexp}
7615 Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
7616 variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
7617 @var{regexp}.
7618
7619 @ignore
7620 This was never implemented.
7621 @kindex info methods
7622 @item info methods
7623 @itemx info methods @var{regexp}
7624 The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
7625 methods within C++ program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
7626 specific set of methods found in the various C++ classes. Many
7627 C++ classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
7628 from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
7629 @code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
7630 which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
7631 @end ignore
7632
7633 @cindex reloading symbols
7634 Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7635 be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
7636 in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
7637 running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
7638 @value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
7639
7640 @table @code
7641 @kindex set symbol-reloading
7642 @item set symbol-reloading on
7643 Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
7644 object file with a particular name is seen again.
7645
7646 @item set symbol-reloading off
7647 Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
7648 same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
7649 running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
7650 should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
7651 may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
7652 several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
7653 name.
7654
7655 @kindex show symbol-reloading
7656 @item show symbol-reloading
7657 Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
7658 @end table
7659
7660 @kindex set opaque-type-resolution
7661 @item set opaque-type-resolution on
7662 Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
7663 declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
7664 @code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
7665 source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
7666 another source file. The default is on.
7667
7668 A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
7669 the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
7670
7671 @item set opaque-type-resolution off
7672 Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
7673 is printed as follows:
7674 @smallexample
7675 @{<no data fields>@}
7676 @end smallexample
7677
7678 @kindex show opaque-type-resolution
7679 @item show opaque-type-resolution
7680 Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
7681
7682 @kindex maint print symbols
7683 @cindex symbol dump
7684 @kindex maint print psymbols
7685 @cindex partial symbol dump
7686 @item maint print symbols @var{filename}
7687 @itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
7688 @itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
7689 Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
7690 These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
7691 symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
7692 symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
7693 collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
7694 only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
7695 command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
7696 use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
7697 symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
7698 files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
7699 @samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
7700 required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
7701 @xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
7702 @value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
7703 @end table
7704
7705 @node Altering
7706 @chapter Altering Execution
7707
7708 Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
7709 find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
7710 correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
7711 experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
7712 program.
7713
7714 For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7715 locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
7716 address, or even return prematurely from a function.
7717
7718 @menu
7719 * Assignment:: Assignment to variables
7720 * Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
7721 * Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
7722 * Returning:: Returning from a function
7723 * Calling:: Calling your program's functions
7724 * Patching:: Patching your program
7725 @end menu
7726
7727 @node Assignment
7728 @section Assignment to variables
7729
7730 @cindex assignment
7731 @cindex setting variables
7732 To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
7733 @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
7734
7735 @example
7736 print x=4
7737 @end example
7738
7739 @noindent
7740 stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
7741 value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
7742 @xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
7743 information on operators in supported languages.
7744
7745 @kindex set variable
7746 @cindex variables, setting
7747 If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
7748 @code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
7749 really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
7750 not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
7751 ,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
7752
7753 If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
7754 appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
7755 variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
7756 to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
7757 program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
7758 a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
7759 command @code{set width}:
7760
7761 @example
7762 (@value{GDBP}) whatis width
7763 type = double
7764 (@value{GDBP}) p width
7765 $4 = 13
7766 (@value{GDBP}) set width=47
7767 Invalid syntax in expression.
7768 @end example
7769
7770 @noindent
7771 The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
7772 order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
7773
7774 @example
7775 (@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
7776 @end example
7777
7778 Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
7779 with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
7780 @code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
7781 your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
7782 to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
7783 the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
7784
7785 @example
7786 @group
7787 (@value{GDBP}) whatis g
7788 type = double
7789 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7790 $1 = 1
7791 (@value{GDBP}) set g=4
7792 (@value{GDBP}) p g
7793 $2 = 1
7794 (@value{GDBP}) r
7795 The program being debugged has been started already.
7796 Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
7797 Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
7798 "/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
7799 Invalid bfd target.
7800 (@value{GDBP}) show g
7801 The current BFD target is "=4".
7802 @end group
7803 @end example
7804
7805 @noindent
7806 The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
7807 @code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
7808 @code{g}, use
7809
7810 @example
7811 (@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
7812 @end example
7813
7814 @value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
7815 freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
7816 and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
7817 same length or shorter.
7818 @comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
7819 @comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
7820
7821 To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
7822 construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
7823 (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
7824 to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
7825 and representation in memory), and
7826
7827 @example
7828 set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
7829 @end example
7830
7831 @noindent
7832 stores the value 4 into that memory location.
7833
7834 @node Jumping
7835 @section Continuing at a different address
7836
7837 Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
7838 it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
7839 an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
7840
7841 @table @code
7842 @kindex jump
7843 @item jump @var{linespec}
7844 Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
7845 immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
7846 source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
7847 @var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
7848 in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
7849 breakpoints}.
7850
7851 The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
7852 the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
7853 register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
7854 a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
7855 be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
7856 of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
7857 confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
7858 executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
7859 well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
7860
7861 @item jump *@var{address}
7862 Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
7863 @end table
7864
7865 @c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
7866 On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
7867 command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
7868 difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
7869 changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
7870 example,
7871
7872 @example
7873 set $pc = 0x485
7874 @end example
7875
7876 @noindent
7877 makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
7878 address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
7879 @xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
7880
7881 The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
7882 up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
7883 that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
7884 detail.
7885
7886 @c @group
7887 @node Signaling
7888 @section Giving your program a signal
7889
7890 @table @code
7891 @kindex signal
7892 @item signal @var{signal}
7893 Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
7894 signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
7895 signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
7896 SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
7897
7898 Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
7899 giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
7900 a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
7901 @code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
7902 signal.
7903
7904 @code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
7905 after executing the command.
7906 @end table
7907 @c @end group
7908
7909 Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
7910 @code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
7911 causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
7912 the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
7913 passes the signal directly to your program.
7914
7915
7916 @node Returning
7917 @section Returning from a function
7918
7919 @table @code
7920 @cindex returning from a function
7921 @kindex return
7922 @item return
7923 @itemx return @var{expression}
7924 You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
7925 command. If you give an
7926 @var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
7927 value.
7928 @end table
7929
7930 When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
7931 (and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
7932 discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
7933 be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
7934
7935 This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
7936 frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
7937 innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
7938 specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
7939 of functions.
7940
7941 The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
7942 program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
7943 returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
7944 and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
7945 selected stack frame returns naturally.
7946
7947 @node Calling
7948 @section Calling program functions
7949
7950 @cindex calling functions
7951 @kindex call
7952 @table @code
7953 @item call @var{expr}
7954 Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
7955 returned values.
7956 @end table
7957
7958 You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
7959 execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
7960 with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
7961 is printed and saved in the value history.
7962
7963 For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
7964 specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
7965 calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
7966 method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
7967 that have separate instruction and data spaces.
7968
7969 @node Patching
7970 @section Patching programs
7971
7972 @cindex patching binaries
7973 @cindex writing into executables
7974 @cindex writing into corefiles
7975
7976 By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
7977 executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
7978 alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
7979 patching your program's binary.
7980
7981 If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
7982 explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
7983 want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
7984 repairs.
7985
7986 @table @code
7987 @kindex set write
7988 @item set write on
7989 @itemx set write off
7990 If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
7991 core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
7992 off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
7993
7994 If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7995 @code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
7996 write}, for your new setting to take effect.
7997
7998 @item show write
7999 @kindex show write
8000 Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
8001 as well as reading.
8002 @end table
8003
8004 @node GDB Files
8005 @chapter @value{GDBN} Files
8006
8007 @value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
8008 both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
8009 program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
8010 @value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
8011
8012 @menu
8013 * Files:: Commands to specify files
8014 * Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
8015 @end menu
8016
8017 @node Files
8018 @section Commands to specify files
8019
8020 @cindex symbol table
8021 @cindex core dump file
8022
8023 You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
8024 way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
8025 @value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
8026 Out of @value{GDBN}}).
8027
8028 Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
8029 @value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
8030 a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
8031 to specify new files are useful.
8032
8033 @table @code
8034 @cindex executable file
8035 @kindex file
8036 @item file @var{filename}
8037 Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
8038 symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
8039 executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
8040 directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
8041 @value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
8042 directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
8043 to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
8044 and your program, using the @code{path} command.
8045
8046 On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
8047 @file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
8048 @var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
8049 @file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
8050 descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
8051 (available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
8052 @code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
8053 for more information.
8054
8055 @item file
8056 @code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
8057 has on both executable file and the symbol table.
8058
8059 @kindex exec-file
8060 @item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8061 Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
8062 in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
8063 if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
8064 discard information on the executable file.
8065
8066 @kindex symbol-file
8067 @item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8068 Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
8069 searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
8070 table and program to run from the same file.
8071
8072 @code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
8073 program's symbol table.
8074
8075 The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
8076 of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
8077 auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
8078 the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
8079 the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
8080
8081 @code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
8082 executing it once.
8083
8084 When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
8085 understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
8086 generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
8087 other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
8088 Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
8089 using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
8090 optimized code.
8091
8092 For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
8093 using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
8094 symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
8095 quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
8096 details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
8097
8098 The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
8099 start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
8100 occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
8101 file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
8102 pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
8103 warnings and messages}.)
8104
8105 We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
8106 symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
8107 symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
8108 still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
8109 in stabs format.
8110
8111 @kindex readnow
8112 @cindex reading symbols immediately
8113 @cindex symbols, reading immediately
8114 @kindex mapped
8115 @cindex memory-mapped symbol file
8116 @cindex saving symbol table
8117 @item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8118 @itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8119 You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
8120 tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
8121 load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
8122 entire symbol table available.
8123
8124 If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
8125 @code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
8126 cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
8127 file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
8128 from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
8129 than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
8130 program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
8131 starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
8132
8133 You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
8134 file has all the symbol information for your program.
8135
8136 The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
8137 @samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
8138 than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
8139 it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
8140 needed.
8141
8142 The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
8143 @value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
8144 symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
8145
8146 @c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
8147 @c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
8148 @c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
8149 @c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
8150 @c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
8151 @c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
8152 @c files.
8153
8154 @kindex core
8155 @kindex core-file
8156 @item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
8157 Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
8158 of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
8159 address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
8160 executable file itself for other parts.
8161
8162 @code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
8163 to be used.
8164
8165 Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
8166 under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
8167 wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
8168 the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
8169 (@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
8170
8171 @kindex add-symbol-file
8172 @cindex dynamic linking
8173 @item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
8174 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
8175 @itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}
8176 The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
8177 information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
8178 when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
8179 into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
8180 address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
8181 this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
8182 of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
8183 section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
8184 @var{address} as an expression.
8185
8186 The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
8187 originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
8188 @code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
8189 thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
8190 instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
8191
8192 @code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
8193
8194 You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
8195 the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
8196 table information for @var{filename}.
8197
8198 @kindex add-shared-symbol-file
8199 @item add-shared-symbol-file
8200 The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
8201 operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
8202 shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
8203 @code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
8204
8205 @kindex section
8206 @item section
8207 The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
8208 the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
8209 section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
8210 specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
8211 separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
8212 the sections and their addresses.
8213
8214 @kindex info files
8215 @kindex info target
8216 @item info files
8217 @itemx info target
8218 @code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
8219 current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
8220 including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
8221 use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
8222 command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
8223 current ones.
8224
8225 @end table
8226
8227 All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
8228 as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
8229 name and remembers it that way.
8230
8231 @cindex shared libraries
8232 @value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
8233 libraries.
8234
8235 @value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
8236 when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
8237 (Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
8238 references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
8239 debugging a core file).
8240
8241 On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
8242 automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
8243
8244 @c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
8245 @c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
8246 @c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
8247
8248 @table @code
8249 @kindex info sharedlibrary
8250 @kindex info share
8251 @item info share
8252 @itemx info sharedlibrary
8253 Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
8254
8255 @kindex sharedlibrary
8256 @kindex share
8257 @item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
8258 @itemx share @var{regex}
8259 Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
8260 Unix regular expression.
8261 As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
8262 required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
8263 @var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
8264 loaded.
8265 @end table
8266
8267 On HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} detects the loading of a shared library
8268 and automatically reads in symbols from the newly loaded library, up to
8269 a threshold that is initially set but that you can modify if you wish.
8270
8271 Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
8272 loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
8273 @var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
8274 automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
8275
8276 To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
8277
8278 @table @code
8279 @kindex set auto-solib-add
8280 @item set auto-solib-add @var{threshold}
8281 Set the autoloading size threshold, in megabytes. If @var{threshold} is
8282 nonzero, symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded
8283 automatically when the inferior begins execution or when the dynamic
8284 linker informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded, until
8285 the symbol table of the program and libraries exceeds this threshold.
8286 Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
8287 @code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 megabytes.
8288
8289 @kindex show auto-solib-add
8290 @item show auto-solib-add
8291 Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
8292 @end table
8293
8294 @node Symbol Errors
8295 @section Errors reading symbol files
8296
8297 While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
8298 such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
8299 output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
8300 they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
8301 debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
8302 about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
8303 only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
8304 times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
8305 to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
8306 complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8307 messages}).
8308
8309 The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
8310
8311 @table @code
8312 @item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
8313
8314 The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
8315 (such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
8316 error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
8317 in its outer scope blocks.
8318
8319 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
8320 the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
8321 may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
8322 function.
8323
8324 @item block at @var{address} out of order
8325
8326 The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
8327 order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
8328 do so.
8329
8330 @value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
8331 locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
8332 can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
8333 @code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
8334 messages}.)
8335
8336 @item bad block start address patched
8337
8338 The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
8339 smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
8340 to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
8341
8342 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
8343 starting on the previous source line.
8344
8345 @item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
8346
8347 @cindex foo
8348 Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
8349 larger than the size of the string table.
8350
8351 @value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
8352 name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
8353 with this name.
8354
8355 @item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
8356
8357 The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
8358 not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
8359 uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
8360
8361 @value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
8362 This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
8363 are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
8364 debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
8365 on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
8366 and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
8367
8368 @item stub type has NULL name
8369
8370 @value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
8371
8372 @item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
8373 The symbol information for a C++ member function is missing some
8374 information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
8375 it.
8376
8377 @item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
8378
8379 @value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
8380
8381 @end table
8382
8383 @node Targets
8384 @chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
8385
8386 @cindex debugging target
8387 @kindex target
8388
8389 A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
8390
8391 Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
8392 in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
8393 you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
8394 flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
8395 host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
8396 realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
8397 command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
8398 (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
8399
8400 @menu
8401 * Active Targets:: Active targets
8402 * Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
8403 * Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
8404 * Remote:: Remote debugging
8405 * KOD:: Kernel Object Display
8406
8407 @end menu
8408
8409 @node Active Targets
8410 @section Active targets
8411
8412 @cindex stacking targets
8413 @cindex active targets
8414 @cindex multiple targets
8415
8416 There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
8417 executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
8418 active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
8419 start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
8420 a core file.
8421
8422 For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
8423 @code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
8424 well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
8425 @value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
8426 first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
8427 requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
8428 are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
8429 read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
8430 executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
8431
8432 When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
8433 target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
8434 commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
8435 an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
8436 process target is active.
8437
8438 Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
8439 core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
8440 files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
8441 the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
8442 process}).
8443
8444 @node Target Commands
8445 @section Commands for managing targets
8446
8447 @table @code
8448 @item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
8449 Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
8450 process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
8451 facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
8452 protocol of the target machine.
8453
8454 Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
8455 typically include things like device names or host names to connect
8456 with, process numbers, and baud rates.
8457
8458 The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
8459 after executing the command.
8460
8461 @kindex help target
8462 @item help target
8463 Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
8464 currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
8465 (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8466
8467 @item help target @var{name}
8468 Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
8469 select it.
8470
8471 @kindex set gnutarget
8472 @item set gnutarget @var{args}
8473 @value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
8474 knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
8475 a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
8476 with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
8477 with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
8478
8479 @quotation
8480 @emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
8481 you must know the actual BFD name.
8482 @end quotation
8483
8484 @noindent
8485 @xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
8486
8487 @kindex show gnutarget
8488 @item show gnutarget
8489 Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
8490 @code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
8491 @value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
8492 and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
8493 @end table
8494
8495 Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
8496 configuration):
8497
8498 @table @code
8499 @kindex target exec
8500 @item target exec @var{program}
8501 An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
8502 @samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
8503
8504 @kindex target core
8505 @item target core @var{filename}
8506 A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
8507 @samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
8508
8509 @kindex target remote
8510 @item target remote @var{dev}
8511 Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
8512 specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
8513 @file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
8514 supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
8515 some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
8516 it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
8517
8518 @kindex target sim
8519 @item target sim
8520 Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
8521 In general,
8522 @example
8523 target sim
8524 load
8525 run
8526 @end example
8527 @noindent
8528 works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
8529 drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
8530 provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
8531 see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
8532 Processors}.
8533
8534 @end table
8535
8536 Some configurations may include these targets as well:
8537
8538 @table @code
8539
8540 @kindex target nrom
8541 @item target nrom @var{dev}
8542 NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
8543
8544 @end table
8545
8546 Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
8547 your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
8548
8549 Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
8550 once you've successfully established a connection.
8551
8552 @table @code
8553
8554 @kindex load @var{filename}
8555 @item load @var{filename}
8556 Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
8557 @value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
8558 is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
8559 on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
8560 @code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
8561 the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
8562
8563 If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
8564 execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
8565 target is @dots{}}''
8566
8567 The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
8568 For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
8569 link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
8570 specifies a fixed address.
8571 @c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
8572
8573 @code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
8574 @end table
8575
8576 @node Byte Order
8577 @section Choosing target byte order
8578
8579 @cindex choosing target byte order
8580 @cindex target byte order
8581
8582 Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
8583 offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
8584 orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
8585 designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
8586 which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
8587 @value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
8588
8589 @table @code
8590 @kindex set endian big
8591 @item set endian big
8592 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
8593
8594 @kindex set endian little
8595 @item set endian little
8596 Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
8597
8598 @kindex set endian auto
8599 @item set endian auto
8600 Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
8601 executable.
8602
8603 @item show endian
8604 Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
8605
8606 @end table
8607
8608 Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
8609 data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
8610 target system.
8611
8612 @node Remote
8613 @section Remote debugging
8614 @cindex remote debugging
8615
8616 If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
8617 @value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
8618 For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
8619 or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
8620 powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
8621
8622 Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
8623 to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
8624 @value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
8625 but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
8626 write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
8627 communicate with @value{GDBN}.
8628
8629 Other remote targets may be available in your
8630 configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
8631
8632 @menu
8633 * Remote Serial:: @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8634 @end menu
8635
8636 @node Remote Serial
8637 @subsection The @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol
8638
8639 @cindex remote serial debugging, overview
8640 To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
8641 @dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
8642 prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
8643 program, you need:
8644
8645 @enumerate
8646 @item
8647 A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
8648 have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
8649 your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
8650
8651 @item
8652 A C subroutine library to support your program's
8653 subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
8654
8655 @item
8656 A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
8657 download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
8658 manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
8659 documentation.
8660 @end enumerate
8661
8662 The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
8663 communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
8664 machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
8665
8666 @table @emph
8667 @item On the host,
8668 @value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
8669 else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
8670 (@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
8671
8672 @item On the target,
8673 you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
8674 implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
8675 subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
8676
8677 On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
8678 @code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
8679 @xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
8680 @end table
8681
8682 The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
8683 machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
8684 @sc{sparc} boards.
8685
8686 @cindex remote serial stub list
8687 These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
8688
8689 @table @code
8690
8691 @item i386-stub.c
8692 @cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
8693 @cindex Intel
8694 @cindex i386
8695 For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
8696
8697 @item m68k-stub.c
8698 @cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
8699 @cindex Motorola 680x0
8700 @cindex m680x0
8701 For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
8702
8703 @item sh-stub.c
8704 @cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
8705 @cindex Hitachi
8706 @cindex SH
8707 For Hitachi SH architectures.
8708
8709 @item sparc-stub.c
8710 @cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
8711 @cindex Sparc
8712 For @sc{sparc} architectures.
8713
8714 @item sparcl-stub.c
8715 @cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
8716 @cindex Fujitsu
8717 @cindex SparcLite
8718 For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
8719
8720 @end table
8721
8722 The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
8723 recently added stubs.
8724
8725 @menu
8726 * Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
8727 * Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
8728 * Debug Session:: Putting it all together
8729 * Protocol:: Definition of the communication protocol
8730 * Server:: Using the `gdbserver' program
8731 * NetWare:: Using the `gdbserve.nlm' program
8732 @end menu
8733
8734 @node Stub Contents
8735 @subsubsection What the stub can do for you
8736
8737 @cindex remote serial stub
8738 The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
8739 subroutines:
8740
8741 @table @code
8742 @item set_debug_traps
8743 @kindex set_debug_traps
8744 @cindex remote serial stub, initialization
8745 This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
8746 program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
8747 beginning of your program.
8748
8749 @item handle_exception
8750 @kindex handle_exception
8751 @cindex remote serial stub, main routine
8752 This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
8753 explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
8754 run when a trap is triggered.
8755
8756 @code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
8757 execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
8758 with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
8759 protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
8760 representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
8761 information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
8762 retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
8763 execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
8764 @code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
8765 machine.
8766
8767 @item breakpoint
8768 @cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
8769 Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
8770 breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
8771 way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
8772 machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
8773 pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
8774 @code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
8775 simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
8776 again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
8777 your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
8778 @value{GDBN} session gets control.
8779
8780 Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
8781 to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
8782 start of your debugging session.
8783 @end table
8784
8785 @node Bootstrapping
8786 @subsubsection What you must do for the stub
8787
8788 @cindex remote stub, support routines
8789 The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
8790 chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
8791 debugging target machine.
8792
8793 First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
8794 serial port.
8795
8796 @table @code
8797 @item int getDebugChar()
8798 @kindex getDebugChar
8799 Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
8800 It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
8801 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8802
8803 @item void putDebugChar(int)
8804 @kindex putDebugChar
8805 Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
8806 It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
8807 different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
8808 @end table
8809
8810 @cindex control C, and remote debugging
8811 @cindex interrupting remote targets
8812 If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
8813 running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
8814 for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
8815 character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
8816 remote system to stop.
8817
8818 Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
8819 probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
8820 is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
8821 @value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
8822
8823 Other routines you need to supply are:
8824
8825 @table @code
8826 @item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
8827 @kindex exceptionHandler
8828 Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
8829 handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
8830 way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
8831 are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
8832 containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
8833 @var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
8834 its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
8835 might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
8836 exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
8837 @var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
8838 and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
8839 you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
8840 should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
8841
8842 For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
8843 gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
8844 should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
8845 @sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
8846 help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
8847
8848 @item void flush_i_cache()
8849 @kindex flush_i_cache
8850 On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
8851 instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
8852 instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
8853
8854 On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
8855 function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
8856 @end table
8857
8858 @noindent
8859 You must also make sure this library routine is available:
8860
8861 @table @code
8862 @item void *memset(void *, int, int)
8863 @kindex memset
8864 This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
8865 memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
8866 @code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
8867 either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
8868 @end table
8869
8870 If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
8871 library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
8872 but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
8873 subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
8874
8875
8876 @node Debug Session
8877 @subsubsection Putting it all together
8878
8879 @cindex remote serial debugging summary
8880 In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
8881 steps.
8882
8883 @enumerate
8884 @item
8885 Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
8886 (@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
8887 @display
8888 @code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
8889 @code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
8890 @end display
8891
8892 @item
8893 Insert these lines near the top of your program:
8894
8895 @example
8896 set_debug_traps();
8897 breakpoint();
8898 @end example
8899
8900 @item
8901 For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
8902 @code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
8903
8904 @example
8905 void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
8906 @end example
8907
8908 @noindent
8909 but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
8910 function in your program, that function is called when
8911 @code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
8912 error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
8913 one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
8914
8915 @item
8916 Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
8917 your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
8918
8919 @item
8920 Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
8921 the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
8922
8923 @item
8924 @c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
8925 @c document that. FIXME.
8926 Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
8927 whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
8928
8929 @item
8930 To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
8931 as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
8932 This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
8933 of its pure text.
8934
8935 @item
8936 @cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
8937 Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
8938 Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
8939 machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
8940 TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
8941 to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
8942 device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
8943
8944 @example
8945 target remote /dev/ttyb
8946 @end example
8947
8948 @cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
8949 To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
8950 @code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
8951 terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
8952
8953 @example
8954 target remote manyfarms:2828
8955 @end example
8956 @end enumerate
8957
8958 Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
8959 step and continue the remote program.
8960
8961 To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
8962 command.
8963
8964 @cindex interrupting remote programs
8965 @cindex remote programs, interrupting
8966 Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
8967 interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
8968 program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
8969 and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
8970 interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
8971
8972 @example
8973 Interrupted while waiting for the program.
8974 Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
8975 @end example
8976
8977 If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
8978 (If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
8979 remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
8980 goes back to waiting.
8981
8982 @node Protocol
8983 @subsubsection Communication protocol
8984
8985 @cindex debugging stub, example
8986 @cindex remote stub, example
8987 @cindex stub example, remote debugging
8988 The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
8989 communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
8990 @value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
8991 these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
8992 implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
8993 with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
8994 organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
8995
8996 However, there may be occasions when you need to know something about
8997 the protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your
8998 target machine, you might want your program to do something special if
8999 it recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
9000
9001 In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
9002 transmitted and received data respectfully.
9003
9004 @cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
9005 @cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
9006 @cindex remote serial protocol
9007 All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
9008 sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
9009 @samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
9010 @samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
9011
9012 @example
9013 @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9014 @end example
9015 @noindent
9016
9017 @cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
9018 @noindent
9019 The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
9020 characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
9021 eight bit unsigned checksum).
9022
9023 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
9024 specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
9025
9026 @example
9027 @code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9028 @end example
9029
9030 @cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
9031 @noindent
9032 That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
9033 has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
9034 since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
9035
9036 @cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
9037 When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
9038 response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
9039 the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
9040 retransmission):
9041
9042 @example
9043 <- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
9044 -> @code{+}
9045 @end example
9046 @noindent
9047
9048 The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
9049 debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
9050 the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
9051 when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
9052
9053 @var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
9054 exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
9055 exceptions).
9056
9057 Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
9058 @samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
9059 HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
9060
9061 Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
9062 @samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
9063 would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
9064
9065 Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
9066 means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
9067 which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
9068 @samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
9069 where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
9070 characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
9071 value greater than 126 should not be used.
9072
9073 Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
9074 loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
9075 character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
9076
9077 So:
9078 @example
9079 "@code{0* }"
9080 @end example
9081 @noindent
9082 means the same as "0000".
9083
9084 The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
9085 error number. That number is not well defined.
9086
9087 For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
9088 (@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
9089 protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
9090 on that response.
9091
9092 A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
9093 @samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
9094 optional.
9095
9096 Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
9097 their corresponding response @var{data}:
9098 @page
9099 @multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
9100 @item Packet
9101 @tab Request
9102 @tab Description
9103
9104 @item extended ops
9105 @tab @code{!}
9106 @tab
9107 Use the extended remote protocol. Sticky---only needs to be set once.
9108 The extended remote protocol supports the @samp{R} packet.
9109 @item
9110 @tab reply @samp{}
9111 @tab
9112 Stubs that support the extended remote protocol return @samp{} which,
9113 unfortunately, is identical to the response returned by stubs that do not
9114 support protocol extensions.
9115
9116 @item last signal
9117 @tab @code{?}
9118 @tab
9119 Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
9120 and continue.
9121 @item
9122 @tab reply
9123 @tab see below
9124
9125
9126 @item reserved
9127 @tab @code{a}
9128 @tab Reserved for future use
9129
9130 @item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
9131 @tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
9132 @tab
9133 @item
9134 @tab
9135 @tab
9136 Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
9137 specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
9138 See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
9139 @item
9140 @tab reply @code{OK}
9141 @item
9142 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9143
9144 @item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
9145 @tab @code{b}@var{baud}
9146 @tab
9147 Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
9148 transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
9149 transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
9150 acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
9151 to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
9152 ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
9153 specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
9154 that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
9155 happened.}
9156
9157 @item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
9158 @tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
9159 @tab
9160 Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
9161 breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
9162 @samp{z} packets.}
9163
9164 @item continue
9165 @tab @code{c}@var{addr}
9166 @tab
9167 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9168 current address.
9169 @item
9170 @tab reply
9171 @tab see below
9172
9173 @item continue with signal
9174 @tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9175 @tab
9176 Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
9177 @code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
9178 @item
9179 @tab reply
9180 @tab see below
9181
9182 @item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
9183 @tab @code{d}
9184 @tab
9185 toggle debug flag.
9186
9187 @item detach
9188 @tab @code{D}
9189 @tab
9190 Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
9191 @value{GDBN} disconnects.
9192 @item
9193 @tab reply @emph{no response}
9194 @tab
9195 @value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
9196
9197 @item reserved
9198 @tab @code{e}
9199 @tab Reserved for future use
9200
9201 @item reserved
9202 @tab @code{E}
9203 @tab Reserved for future use
9204
9205 @item reserved
9206 @tab @code{f}
9207 @tab Reserved for future use
9208
9209 @item reserved
9210 @tab @code{F}
9211 @tab Reserved for future use
9212
9213 @item read registers
9214 @tab @code{g}
9215 @tab Read general registers.
9216 @item
9217 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9218 @tab
9219 Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
9220 with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
9221 each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
9222 determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
9223 @var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
9224 @code{g} packets is specified below.
9225 @item
9226 @tab @code{E}@var{NN}
9227 @tab for an error.
9228
9229 @item write regs
9230 @tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
9231 @tab
9232 See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
9233 @item
9234 @tab reply @code{OK}
9235 @tab for success
9236 @item
9237 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9238 @tab for an error
9239
9240 @item reserved
9241 @tab @code{h}
9242 @tab Reserved for future use
9243
9244 @item set thread
9245 @tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
9246 @tab
9247 Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
9248 @samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
9249 continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
9250 thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
9251 @item
9252 @tab reply @code{OK}
9253 @tab for success
9254 @item
9255 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9256 @tab for an error
9257
9258 @c FIXME: JTC:
9259 @c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
9260 @c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
9261 @c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
9262 @c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
9263 @c described. For example:
9264 @c
9265 @c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9266 @c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
9267 @c otherwise returns current registers.
9268 @c
9269 @c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
9270 @c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
9271 @c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
9272
9273 @item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
9274 @tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
9275 @tab
9276 Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
9277 present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
9278 step starting at that address.
9279
9280 @item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
9281 @tab @code{I}
9282 @tab
9283 See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
9284
9285 @item reserved
9286 @tab @code{j}
9287 @tab Reserved for future use
9288
9289 @item reserved
9290 @tab @code{J}
9291 @tab Reserved for future use
9292
9293 @item kill request
9294 @tab @code{k}
9295 @tab
9296 FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how operate when a specific
9297 thread context has been selected (ie. does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
9298
9299 @item reserved
9300 @tab @code{l}
9301 @tab Reserved for future use
9302
9303 @item reserved
9304 @tab @code{L}
9305 @tab Reserved for future use
9306
9307 @item read memory
9308 @tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9309 @tab
9310 Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9311 Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
9312 using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
9313 transfer mechanism is needed.}
9314 @item
9315 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9316 @tab
9317 @var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
9318 to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
9319 sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
9320 @emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
9321 @item
9322 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9323 @tab @var{NN} is errno
9324
9325 @item write mem
9326 @tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
9327 @tab
9328 Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
9329 @var{XX...} is the data.
9330 @item
9331 @tab reply @code{OK}
9332 @tab for success
9333 @item
9334 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9335 @tab
9336 for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
9337 written).
9338
9339 @item reserved
9340 @tab @code{n}
9341 @tab Reserved for future use
9342
9343 @item reserved
9344 @tab @code{N}
9345 @tab Reserved for future use
9346
9347 @item reserved
9348 @tab @code{o}
9349 @tab Reserved for future use
9350
9351 @item reserved
9352 @tab @code{O}
9353 @tab Reserved for future use
9354
9355 @item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
9356 @tab @code{p}@var{n...}
9357 @tab
9358 See write register.
9359 @item
9360 @tab return @var{r....}
9361 @tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
9362
9363 @item write reg
9364 @tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
9365 @tab
9366 Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
9367 digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
9368 @item
9369 @tab reply @code{OK}
9370 @tab for success
9371 @item
9372 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9373 @tab for an error
9374
9375 @item general query
9376 @tab @code{q}@var{query}
9377 @tab
9378 Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
9379 have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
9380 company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
9381 optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
9382 must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
9383 @item
9384 @tab reply @code{XX...}
9385 @tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
9386 @item
9387 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9388 @tab error reply
9389 @item
9390 @tab reply @samp{}
9391 @tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
9392
9393 @item general set
9394 @tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
9395 @tab
9396 Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
9397 naming conventions.
9398
9399 @item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
9400 @tab @code{r}
9401 @tab
9402 Reset the entire system.
9403
9404 @item remote restart
9405 @tab @code{R}@var{XX}
9406 @tab
9407 Restart the remote server. @var{XX} while needed has no clear
9408 definition. FIXME: @emph{An example interaction explaining how this
9409 packet is used in extended-remote mode is needed}.
9410
9411 @item step
9412 @tab @code{s}@var{addr}
9413 @tab
9414 @var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
9415 same address.
9416 @item
9417 @tab reply
9418 @tab see below
9419
9420 @item step with signal
9421 @tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
9422 @tab
9423 Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
9424 @item
9425 @tab reply
9426 @tab see below
9427
9428 @item search
9429 @tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
9430 @tab
9431 Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
9432 @var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
9433 bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
9434
9435 @item thread alive
9436 @tab @code{T}@var{XX}
9437 @tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
9438 @item
9439 @tab reply @code{OK}
9440 @tab thread is still alive
9441 @item
9442 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9443 @tab thread is dead
9444
9445 @item reserved
9446 @tab @code{u}
9447 @tab Reserved for future use
9448
9449 @item reserved
9450 @tab @code{U}
9451 @tab Reserved for future use
9452
9453 @item reserved
9454 @tab @code{v}
9455 @tab Reserved for future use
9456
9457 @item reserved
9458 @tab @code{V}
9459 @tab Reserved for future use
9460
9461 @item reserved
9462 @tab @code{w}
9463 @tab Reserved for future use
9464
9465 @item reserved
9466 @tab @code{W}
9467 @tab Reserved for future use
9468
9469 @item reserved
9470 @tab @code{x}
9471 @tab Reserved for future use
9472
9473 @item write mem (binary)
9474 @tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
9475 @tab
9476 @var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
9477 binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
9478 escaped using @code{0x7d}.
9479 @item
9480 @tab reply @code{OK}
9481 @tab for success
9482 @item
9483 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9484 @tab for an error
9485
9486 @item reserved
9487 @tab @code{y}
9488 @tab Reserved for future use
9489
9490 @item reserved
9491 @tab @code{Y}
9492 @tab Reserved for future use
9493
9494 @item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9495 @tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9496 @tab
9497 See @samp{Z}.
9498
9499 @item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
9500 @tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9501 @tab
9502 @var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
9503 breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
9504 @samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
9505 bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
9506 the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
9507 @var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
9508 potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
9509 implemented in an idempotent way.
9510 @item
9511 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9512 @tab for an error
9513 @item
9514 @tab reply @code{OK}
9515 @tab for success
9516 @item
9517 @tab @samp{}
9518 @tab If not supported.
9519
9520 @item reserved
9521 @tab <other>
9522 @tab Reserved for future use
9523
9524 @end multitable
9525
9526 The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
9527 receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
9528 @samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
9529 when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
9530 number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
9531 conventions is used.
9532
9533 @multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
9534
9535 @item @code{S}@var{AA}
9536 @tab @var{AA} is the signal number
9537
9538 @item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
9539 @tab
9540 @var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
9541 (hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
9542 by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
9543 thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
9544 starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
9545 @var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
9546 extend the protocol.
9547
9548 @item @code{W}@var{AA}
9549 @tab
9550 The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
9551 applicable for certains sorts of targets.
9552
9553 @item @code{X}@var{AA}
9554 @tab
9555 The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
9556
9557 @item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
9558 @tab
9559 @var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
9560 @var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
9561 @emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
9562 this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
9563 spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
9564 debugger.}
9565
9566 @item @code{O}@var{XX...}
9567 @tab
9568 @var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
9569 while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
9570 for 'W', 'T', etc.
9571
9572 @end multitable
9573
9574 The following set and query packets have already been defined.
9575
9576 @multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
9577
9578 @item current thread
9579 @tab @code{q}@code{C}
9580 @tab Return the current thread id.
9581 @item
9582 @tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
9583 @tab
9584 Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
9585 @item
9586 @tab reply *
9587 @tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
9588
9589 @item all thread ids
9590 @tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9591 @item
9592 @tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
9593 @tab
9594 Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
9595 may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
9596 works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
9597 obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
9598 be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
9599 sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
9600 @item
9601 @tab
9602 @tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
9603 @item
9604 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
9605 @tab A single thread id
9606 @item
9607 @tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
9608 @tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
9609 @item
9610 @tab reply @code{l}
9611 @tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
9612 @item
9613 @tab
9614 @tab
9615 In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
9616 or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
9617 respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
9618 @code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
9619 (lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
9620
9621 @item extra thread info
9622 @tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
9623 @tab
9624 @item
9625 @tab
9626 @tab
9627 Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
9628 Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
9629 the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
9630 thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
9631 The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
9632 Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
9633 "Blocked on Mutex".
9634 @item
9635 @tab reply @var{XX...}
9636 @tab
9637 Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
9638 printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
9639 attributes.
9640
9641 @item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
9642 @tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
9643 @tab
9644 @item
9645 @tab
9646 @tab
9647 Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
9648 digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
9649 subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
9650 number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
9651 (eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
9652 returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
9653 @item
9654 @tab
9655 @tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
9656 query (see above).
9657 @item
9658 @tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
9659 @tab
9660 @item
9661 @tab
9662 @tab
9663 Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
9664 returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
9665 and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
9666 digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
9667 a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
9668 digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
9669
9670 @item compute CRC of memory block
9671 @tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
9672 @tab
9673 @item
9674 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9675 @tab An error (such as memory fault)
9676 @item
9677 @tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
9678 @tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
9679
9680 @item query sect offs
9681 @tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
9682 @tab
9683 Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
9684 image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
9685 response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
9686 offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
9687 @item
9688 @tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
9689
9690 @item thread info request
9691 @tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
9692 @tab
9693 @item
9694 @tab
9695 @tab
9696 Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
9697 encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
9698 @item
9699 @tab reply *
9700 @tab
9701 See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
9702
9703 @item remote command
9704 @tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
9705 @tab
9706 @item
9707 @tab
9708 @tab
9709 @var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
9710 execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
9711 Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
9712 number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
9713 packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
9714 stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
9715 @item
9716 @tab reply @code{OK}
9717 @tab
9718 A command response with no output.
9719 @item
9720 @tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
9721 @tab
9722 A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
9723 @item
9724 @tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
9725 @tab
9726 Indicate a badly formed request.
9727
9728 @item
9729 @tab reply @samp{}
9730 @tab
9731 When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
9732
9733 @end multitable
9734
9735 The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
9736 In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
9737 bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
9738 space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
9739 The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
9740 least-significant.
9741
9742 @multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
9743
9744 @item MIPS32
9745 @tab
9746 All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
9747 32 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
9748 registers; fsr; fir; fp.
9749
9750 @item MIPS64
9751 @tab
9752 All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
9753 thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
9754 as @code{MIPS32}.
9755
9756 @end multitable
9757
9758 Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
9759 does not get any direct output:
9760
9761 @example
9762 <- @code{R00}
9763 -> @code{+}
9764 @emph{target restarts}
9765 <- @code{?}
9766 -> @code{+}
9767 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9768 <- @code{+}
9769 @end example
9770
9771 Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
9772
9773 @example
9774 <- @code{G1445...}
9775 -> @code{+}
9776 <- @code{s}
9777 -> @code{+}
9778 @emph{time passes}
9779 -> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
9780 <- @code{+}
9781 <- @code{g}
9782 -> @code{+}
9783 -> @code{1455...}
9784 <- @code{+}
9785 @end example
9786
9787 @node Server
9788 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9789
9790 @kindex gdbserver
9791 @cindex remote connection without stubs
9792 @code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9793 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9794 @code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9795
9796 @code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9797 because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9798 that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9799 @code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9800 @value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9801 because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9802 also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9803 started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9804 Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9805 the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9806 do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9807 by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9808 choice for debugging.
9809
9810 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9811 or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9812 protocol.
9813
9814 @table @emph
9815 @item On the target machine,
9816 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9817 @code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9818 strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9819 system does all the symbol handling.
9820
9821 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9822 the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9823 syntax is:
9824
9825 @smallexample
9826 target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9827 @end smallexample
9828
9829 @var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9830 hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9831 @samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9832 @file{/dev/com1}:
9833
9834 @smallexample
9835 target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9836 @end smallexample
9837
9838 @code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9839 with it.
9840
9841 To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9842
9843 @smallexample
9844 target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9845 @end smallexample
9846
9847 The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9848 specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9849 TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9850 expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9851 (Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9852 you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9853 TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9854 reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9855 conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9856 and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9857 @code{target remote} command.
9858
9859 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9860 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9861 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9862 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9863 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9864 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
9865 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9866 is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9867 @file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9868 @code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9869
9870 @smallexample
9871 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9872 @end smallexample
9873
9874 @noindent
9875 communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
9876
9877 @smallexample
9878 (@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
9879 @end smallexample
9880
9881 @noindent
9882 communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
9883 For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
9884 the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
9885 text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
9886 @samp{Connection refused}.
9887 @end table
9888
9889 @node NetWare
9890 @subsubsection Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
9891
9892 @kindex gdbserve.nlm
9893 @code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
9894 allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9895 @code{target remote}.
9896
9897 @value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
9898 using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
9899
9900 @table @emph
9901 @item On the target machine,
9902 you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9903 @code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
9904 can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
9905 host system does all the symbol handling.
9906
9907 To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
9908 @value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
9909 program. The syntax is:
9910
9911 @smallexample
9912 load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
9913 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9914 @end smallexample
9915
9916 @var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
9917 the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
9918 to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
9919
9920 For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
9921 communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
9922 using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
9923
9924 @smallexample
9925 load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
9926 @end smallexample
9927
9928 @item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9929 you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9930 symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9931 using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9932 (You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9933 running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
9934 remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
9935 argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
9936 @file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
9937
9938 @smallexample
9939 (@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9940 @end smallexample
9941
9942 @noindent
9943 communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
9944 @end table
9945
9946 @node KOD
9947 @section Kernel Object Display
9948
9949 @cindex kernel object display
9950 @cindex kernel object
9951 @cindex KOD
9952
9953 Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9954 @value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9955 and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9956 mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9957 displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9958
9959 Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9960 @value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9961
9962 @example
9963 (@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9964 @end example
9965
9966 If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9967 about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9968 which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9969 after the operating system:
9970
9971 @example
9972 (@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9973 List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9974 Object Description
9975 any Any and all objects
9976 @end example
9977
9978 Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9979 by the kernel.
9980
9981 There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9982 is supported other than to try it.
9983
9984
9985 @node Configurations
9986 @chapter Configuration-Specific Information
9987
9988 While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
9989 cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
9990 describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
9991
9992 There are three major categories of configurations: native
9993 configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
9994 operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
9995 different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
9996 are quite different from each other.
9997
9998 @menu
9999 * Native::
10000 * Embedded OS::
10001 * Embedded Processors::
10002 * Architectures::
10003 @end menu
10004
10005 @node Native
10006 @section Native
10007
10008 This section describes details specific to particular native
10009 configurations.
10010
10011 @menu
10012 * HP-UX:: HP-UX
10013 * SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10014 @end menu
10015
10016 @node HP-UX
10017 @subsection HP-UX
10018
10019 On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10020 begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10021 name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
10022
10023 @node SVR4 Process Information
10024 @subsection SVR4 process information
10025
10026 @kindex /proc
10027 @cindex process image
10028
10029 Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10030 used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10031 subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10032 this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10033 several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10034 @code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10035 @code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10036 and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
10037
10038 @table @code
10039 @kindex info proc
10040 @item info proc
10041 Summarize available information about the process.
10042
10043 @kindex info proc mappings
10044 @item info proc mappings
10045 Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10046 on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10047
10048 @kindex info proc times
10049 @item info proc times
10050 Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10051 its children.
10052
10053 @kindex info proc id
10054 @item info proc id
10055 Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10056 the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
10057
10058 @kindex info proc status
10059 @item info proc status
10060 General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10061 stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10062 received.
10063
10064 @item info proc all
10065 Show all the above information about the process.
10066 @end table
10067
10068 @node Embedded OS
10069 @section Embedded Operating Systems
10070
10071 This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10072 embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10073 architectures.
10074
10075 @menu
10076 * VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10077 @end menu
10078
10079 @value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10080 various real-time operating systems.
10081
10082 @node VxWorks
10083 @subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10084
10085 @cindex VxWorks
10086
10087 @table @code
10088
10089 @kindex target vxworks
10090 @item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10091 A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10092 is the target system's machine name or IP address.
10093
10094 @end table
10095
10096 On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10097 current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
10098
10099 @value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10100 VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10101 the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10102 both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10103 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10104 installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10105 @value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
10106
10107 @table @code
10108 @item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10109 @kindex vxworks-timeout
10110 All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10111 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10112 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10113 your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10114 of a thin network line.
10115 @end table
10116
10117 The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10118 this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10119 procedures.
10120
10121 @kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10122 To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10123 to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10124 library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10125 VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10126 kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10127 source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10128 information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10129 manual.
10130 @c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
10131
10132 Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10133 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10134 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10135 @code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
10136
10137 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
10138
10139 @example
10140 (vxgdb)
10141 @end example
10142
10143 @menu
10144 * VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10145 * VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10146 * VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10147 @end menu
10148
10149 @node VxWorks Connection
10150 @subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
10151
10152 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10153 network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
10154
10155 @example
10156 (vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10157 @end example
10158
10159 @need 750
10160 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
10161
10162 @smallexample
10163 Attaching remote machine across net...
10164 Connected to tt.
10165 @end smallexample
10166
10167 @need 1000
10168 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10169 loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10170 these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10171 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10172 to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
10173
10174 @example
10175 prog.o: No such file or directory.
10176 @end example
10177
10178 When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10179 the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10180 command again.
10181
10182 @node VxWorks Download
10183 @subsubsection VxWorks download
10184
10185 @cindex download to VxWorks
10186 If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10187 object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10188 @code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10189 incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10190 command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10191 to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10192 table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10193 the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10194 filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10195 Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10196 to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10197 the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10198 @file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10199 and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10200 program, type this on VxWorks:
10201
10202 @example
10203 -> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10204 @end example
10205
10206 @noindent
10207 Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
10208
10209 @example
10210 (vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10211 (vxgdb) load prog.o
10212 @end example
10213
10214 @value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
10215
10216 @smallexample
10217 Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10218 @end smallexample
10219
10220 You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10221 after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10222 this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10223 auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10224 history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10225 debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10226 table.)
10227
10228 @node VxWorks Attach
10229 @subsubsection Running tasks
10230
10231 @cindex running VxWorks tasks
10232 You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10233 follows:
10234
10235 @example
10236 (vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10237 @end example
10238
10239 @noindent
10240 where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10241 or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10242 the time of attachment.
10243
10244 @node Embedded Processors
10245 @section Embedded Processors
10246
10247 This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10248 configurations.
10249
10250 @menu
10251 * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
10252 * ARM:: ARM
10253 * H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10254 * H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10255 * i960:: Intel i960
10256 * M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10257 * M68K:: Motorola M68K
10258 * M88K:: Motorola M88K
10259 * MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10260 * PA:: HP PA Embedded
10261 * PowerPC: PowerPC
10262 * SH:: Hitachi SH
10263 * Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10264 * Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10265 * ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10266 * Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10267 @end menu
10268
10269 @node A29K Embedded
10270 @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10271
10272 @menu
10273 * A29K UDI::
10274 * A29K EB29K::
10275 * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10276 * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10277 * Remote Log:: Remote log
10278 @end menu
10279
10280 @table @code
10281
10282 @kindex target adapt
10283 @item target adapt @var{dev}
10284 Adapt monitor for A29K.
10285
10286 @kindex target amd-eb
10287 @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10288 @cindex AMD EB29K
10289 Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10290 @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10291 @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10292 name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10293 @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10294
10295 @end table
10296
10297 @node A29K UDI
10298 @subsubsection A29K UDI
10299
10300 @cindex UDI
10301 @cindex AMD29K via UDI
10302
10303 @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10304 protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10305 configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10306 program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10307 use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10308 @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10309
10310 @table @code
10311 @item target udi @var{keyword}
10312 @kindex udi
10313 Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10314 @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10315 This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10316 connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10317 working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10318 to its pathname.
10319 @end table
10320
10321 @node A29K EB29K
10322 @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10323
10324 @cindex EB29K board
10325 @cindex running 29K programs
10326
10327 AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10328 with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10329 term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10330 @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10331 must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10332 board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10333 assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10334 @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10335
10336 @node Comms (EB29K)
10337 @subsubsection Communications setup
10338
10339 The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10340 in DOS on the PC:
10341
10342 @example
10343 C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10344 @end example
10345
10346 @noindent
10347 This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10348 bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10349 you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10350 end of the connection as well.
10351 @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10352 @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10353 @c
10354 @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10355 @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10356 @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10357 @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10358 @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
10359
10360 To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10361 the following at the DOS console:
10362
10363 @example
10364 C:\> CTTY com1
10365 @end example
10366
10367 @noindent
10368 (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10369 the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10370 had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
10371
10372 From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10373 @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10374
10375 @example
10376 cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10377 @end example
10378
10379 @noindent
10380 The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10381 serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10382 may look something like the following:
10383
10384 @example
10385 tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10386 @end example
10387
10388 @noindent
10389 Your system may require a different name where we show
10390 @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10391 parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10392 @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10393 system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10394 @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10395 @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10396 @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10397 @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10398 @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10399 @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10400 @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10401 @c
10402 @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
10403 @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
10404 @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
10405
10406 @kindex EBMON
10407 Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
10408 directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
10409 start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
10410 with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
10411 @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
10412 @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
10413
10414 @example
10415 C:\> G:
10416
10417 G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
10418
10419 G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
10420 Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
10421 Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
10422 Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
10423
10424 Enter '?' or 'H' for help
10425
10426 PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
10427 I/O Base = 0x208
10428 Memory Base = 0xd0000
10429
10430 Data Memory Size = 2048KB
10431 Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
10432 Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
10433
10434 PageSize = 0x400
10435 Register Stack Size = 0x800
10436 Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
10437
10438 CPU PRL = 0x3
10439 Am29027 Available = No
10440 Byte Write Available = Yes
10441
10442 # ~.
10443 @end example
10444
10445 Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
10446 typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
10447 running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
10448
10449 For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
10450 way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
10451 system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
10452 PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
10453 something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
10454 other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
10455 from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
10456 serial line.
10457
10458 @node gdb-EB29K
10459 @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
10460
10461 Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
10462 program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
10463 name of your 29K program:
10464
10465 @example
10466 cd /usr/joe/work29k
10467 @value{GDBP} myfoo
10468 @end example
10469
10470 @need 500
10471 Now you can use the @code{target} command:
10472
10473 @example
10474 target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
10475 @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
10476 @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
10477 @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10478 @end example
10479
10480 @noindent
10481 In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
10482 @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
10483 @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
10484 In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
10485 a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
10486 the name on the Unix side.
10487
10488 At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
10489 to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
10490 @code{run}.
10491
10492 To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
10493 command.
10494
10495 To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
10496 once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
10497 @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
10498 @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
10499 Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
10500 and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
10501
10502 @node Remote Log
10503 @subsubsection Remote log
10504 @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
10505 @cindex log file for EB29K
10506
10507 The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
10508 current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
10509 @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
10510 of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
10511 another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
10512 unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
10513
10514 @node ARM
10515 @subsection ARM
10516
10517 @table @code
10518
10519 @kindex target rdi
10520 @item target rdi @var{dev}
10521 ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
10522 use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
10523 monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
10524
10525 @kindex target rdp
10526 @item target rdp @var{dev}
10527 ARM Demon monitor.
10528
10529 @end table
10530
10531 @node H8/300
10532 @subsection Hitachi H8/300
10533
10534 @table @code
10535
10536 @kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
10537 @item target hms @var{dev}
10538 A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
10539 Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
10540 line and the communications speed used.
10541
10542 @kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
10543 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
10544 E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
10545
10546 @kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
10547 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
10548 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
10549 @itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
10550 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
10551
10552 @end table
10553
10554 @cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
10555 @cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
10556 @cindex download to Hitachi SH
10557 @cindex Hitachi SH download
10558 When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
10559 board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
10560 board and also opens it as the current executable target for
10561 @value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
10562
10563 @value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
10564 Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
10565
10566 @enumerate
10567 @item
10568 that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
10569 for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
10570 emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
10571 the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
10572 H8/300, or H8/500.)
10573
10574 @item
10575 what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
10576 serial device available on your host is the default).
10577
10578 @item
10579 what speed to use over the serial device.
10580 @end enumerate
10581
10582 @menu
10583 * Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
10584 * Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
10585 * Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
10586 @end menu
10587
10588 @node Hitachi Boards
10589 @subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
10590
10591 @c only for Unix hosts
10592 @kindex device
10593 @cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
10594 Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
10595 need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
10596 first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
10597 hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
10598
10599 @kindex speed
10600 @cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
10601 @code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
10602 speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
10603 hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
10604 the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
10605 @w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
10606
10607 The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
10608 use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
10609 use a DOS host,
10610 @value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
10611 called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
10612 through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
10613 to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
10614
10615 The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
10616 program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
10617 sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
10618 the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
10619
10620 First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
10621 board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
10622 port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
10623 When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
10624 debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
10625 for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
10626 @code{COM2}.
10627
10628 @example
10629 C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
10630 C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
10631
10632 Resident portion of MODE loaded
10633
10634 COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
10635
10636 @end example
10637
10638 @quotation
10639 @emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
10640 @code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
10641 disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
10642 your development board.
10643 @end quotation
10644
10645 @kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
10646 Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
10647 connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
10648 the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
10649 you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
10650 commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
10651 cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
10652 download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
10653 the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
10654 (If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
10655 executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
10656 @code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
10657 itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
10658
10659 @smallexample
10660 (eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
10661 @value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
10662 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
10663 the conditions.
10664 There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
10665 for details.
10666 @value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
10667 (@value{GDBP}) target hms
10668 Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
10669 (@value{GDBP}) load t.x
10670 .text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
10671 .data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
10672 .stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
10673 @end smallexample
10674
10675 At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
10676 you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
10677 sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
10678 @code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
10679 resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
10680 @code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
10681
10682 Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
10683 available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
10684 you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
10685
10686 Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
10687 @itemize @bullet
10688 @item
10689 to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
10690 no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
10691
10692 @item
10693 to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
10694 normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
10695 to detect program completion.
10696 @end itemize
10697
10698 In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
10699 development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
10700
10701 @node Hitachi ICE
10702 @subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
10703
10704 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
10705 You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
10706 Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
10707 e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
10708
10709 @table @code
10710 @item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
10711 Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
10712 @var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
10713 @samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
10714 (for example, @samp{9600}).
10715
10716 @item target e7000 @var{hostname}
10717 If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
10718 specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
10719 @end table
10720
10721 @node Hitachi Special
10722 @subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
10723
10724 Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
10725
10726 @table @code
10727
10728 @kindex set machine
10729 @kindex show machine
10730 @item set machine h8300
10731 @itemx set machine h8300h
10732 Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
10733 architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
10734 to check which variant is currently in effect.
10735
10736 @end table
10737
10738 @node H8/500
10739 @subsection H8/500
10740
10741 @table @code
10742
10743 @kindex set memory @var{mod}
10744 @cindex memory models, H8/500
10745 @item set memory @var{mod}
10746 @itemx show memory
10747 Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
10748 @samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
10749 memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
10750 @code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
10751
10752 @end table
10753
10754 @node i960
10755 @subsection Intel i960
10756
10757 @table @code
10758
10759 @kindex target mon960
10760 @item target mon960 @var{dev}
10761 MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
10762
10763 @kindex target nindy
10764 @item target nindy @var{devicename}
10765 An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
10766 the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
10767 @file{/dev/ttya}.
10768
10769 @end table
10770
10771 @cindex Nindy
10772 @cindex i960
10773 @dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
10774 @value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
10775 tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
10776
10777 @itemize @bullet
10778 @item
10779 Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
10780 Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
10781
10782 @item
10783 By responding to a prompt on startup;
10784
10785 @item
10786 By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
10787 session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
10788
10789 @end itemize
10790
10791 @cindex download to Nindy-960
10792 With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
10793 downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
10794 @value{GDBN}.
10795
10796 @menu
10797 * Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
10798 * Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
10799 * Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
10800 @end menu
10801
10802 @node Nindy Startup
10803 @subsubsection Startup with Nindy
10804
10805 If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
10806 options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
10807 reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
10808
10809 @example
10810 Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
10811 @end example
10812
10813 @noindent
10814 Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
10815 identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
10816 simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
10817 with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
10818 use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
10819
10820 @node Nindy Options
10821 @subsubsection Options for Nindy
10822
10823 These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
10824 Nindy-960 board attached:
10825
10826 @table @code
10827 @item -r @var{port}
10828 Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
10829 to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
10830 configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
10831 @var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
10832 device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
10833 suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
10834
10835 @item -O
10836 (An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
10837 the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
10838 This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
10839 target architecture.
10840
10841 @quotation
10842 @emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
10843 connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
10844 fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
10845 attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
10846 this process with an interrupt.
10847 @end quotation
10848
10849 @item -brk
10850 Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
10851 system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
10852
10853 @quotation
10854 @emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
10855 requires; it only works with a few boards.
10856 @end quotation
10857 @end table
10858
10859 The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
10860 port.
10861
10862 @c @group
10863 @node Nindy Reset
10864 @subsubsection Nindy reset command
10865
10866 @table @code
10867 @item reset
10868 @kindex reset
10869 For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
10870 system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
10871 circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
10872 a break is detected.
10873 @end table
10874 @c @end group
10875
10876 @node M32R/D
10877 @subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
10878
10879 @table @code
10880
10881 @kindex target m32r
10882 @item target m32r @var{dev}
10883 Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
10884
10885 @end table
10886
10887 @node M68K
10888 @subsection M68k
10889
10890 The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
10891 target command for the following ROM monitors.
10892
10893 @table @code
10894
10895 @kindex target abug
10896 @item target abug @var{dev}
10897 ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
10898
10899 @kindex target cpu32bug
10900 @item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
10901 CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10902
10903 @kindex target dbug
10904 @item target dbug @var{dev}
10905 dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
10906
10907 @kindex target est
10908 @item target est @var{dev}
10909 EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
10910
10911 @kindex target rom68k
10912 @item target rom68k @var{dev}
10913 ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
10914
10915 @end table
10916
10917 If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
10918 instead have only a single special target command:
10919
10920 @table @code
10921
10922 @kindex target es1800
10923 @item target es1800 @var{dev}
10924 ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
10925
10926 @end table
10927
10928 [context?]
10929
10930 @table @code
10931
10932 @kindex target rombug
10933 @item target rombug @var{dev}
10934 ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
10935
10936 @end table
10937
10938 @node M88K
10939 @subsection M88K
10940
10941 @table @code
10942
10943 @kindex target bug
10944 @item target bug @var{dev}
10945 BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
10946
10947 @end table
10948
10949 @node MIPS Embedded
10950 @subsection MIPS Embedded
10951
10952 @cindex MIPS boards
10953 @value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
10954 MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
10955 you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
10956
10957 @need 1000
10958 Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
10959
10960 @table @code
10961 @item target mips @var{port}
10962 @kindex target mips @var{port}
10963 To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
10964 name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
10965 command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
10966 the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
10967 been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
10968 download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
10969
10970 For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
10971 port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
10972 debugger:
10973
10974 @example
10975 host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
10976 @value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
10977 (@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
10978 (@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
10979 (@value{GDBP}) run
10980 @end example
10981
10982 @item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
10983 On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
10984 connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
10985 concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
10986 @samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
10987
10988 @item target pmon @var{port}
10989 @kindex target pmon @var{port}
10990 PMON ROM monitor.
10991
10992 @item target ddb @var{port}
10993 @kindex target ddb @var{port}
10994 NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
10995
10996 @item target lsi @var{port}
10997 @kindex target lsi @var{port}
10998 LSI variant of PMON.
10999
11000 @kindex target r3900
11001 @item target r3900 @var{dev}
11002 Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
11003
11004 @kindex target array
11005 @item target array @var{dev}
11006 Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
11007
11008 @end table
11009
11010
11011 @noindent
11012 @value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
11013
11014 @table @code
11015 @item set processor @var{args}
11016 @itemx show processor
11017 @kindex set processor @var{args}
11018 @kindex show processor
11019 Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11020 processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11021 For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11022 to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11023 Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11024 is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11025 @value{GDBN} is using.
11026
11027 @item set mipsfpu double
11028 @itemx set mipsfpu single
11029 @itemx set mipsfpu none
11030 @itemx show mipsfpu
11031 @kindex set mipsfpu
11032 @kindex show mipsfpu
11033 @cindex MIPS remote floating point
11034 @cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11035 If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11036 coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11037 need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11038 file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11039 functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11040 @value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11041 functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11042 with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11043 processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11044 double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11045 @samp{set mipsfpu double}.
11046
11047 In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11048 floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11049 and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
11050
11051 As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11052 @samp{show mipsfpu}.
11053
11054 @item set remotedebug @var{n}
11055 @itemx show remotedebug
11056 @kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11057 @kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11058 @cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11059 @cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11060 @c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11061 @c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11062 You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11063 by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11064 @samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11065 to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11066 at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
11067
11068 @item set timeout @var{seconds}
11069 @itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11070 @itemx show timeout
11071 @itemx show retransmit-timeout
11072 @cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11073 @cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11074 @kindex set timeout
11075 @kindex show timeout
11076 @kindex set retransmit-timeout
11077 @kindex show retransmit-timeout
11078 You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11079 remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11080 default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11081 waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11082 retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11083 You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11084 retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11085 @value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
11086
11087 The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11088 is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11089 forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11090 to run before stopping.
11091 @end table
11092
11093 @node PowerPC
11094 @subsection PowerPC
11095
11096 @table @code
11097
11098 @kindex target dink32
11099 @item target dink32 @var{dev}
11100 DINK32 ROM monitor.
11101
11102 @kindex target ppcbug
11103 @item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11104 @kindex target ppcbug1
11105 @item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11106 PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
11107
11108 @kindex target sds
11109 @item target sds @var{dev}
11110 SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11111
11112 @end table
11113
11114 @node PA
11115 @subsection HP PA Embedded
11116
11117 @table @code
11118
11119 @kindex target op50n
11120 @item target op50n @var{dev}
11121 OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11122
11123 @kindex target w89k
11124 @item target w89k @var{dev}
11125 W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
11126
11127 @end table
11128
11129 @node SH
11130 @subsection Hitachi SH
11131
11132 @table @code
11133
11134 @kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11135 @item target hms @var{dev}
11136 A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11137 commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11138 the communications speed used.
11139
11140 @kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11141 @item target e7000 @var{dev}
11142 E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
11143
11144 @kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11145 @kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11146 @item target sh3 @var{dev}
11147 @item target sh3e @var{dev}
11148 Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11149
11150 @end table
11151
11152 @node Sparclet
11153 @subsection Tsqware Sparclet
11154
11155 @cindex Sparclet
11156
11157 @value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11158 Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11159 @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11160 both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11161 @code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
11162
11163 @table @code
11164 @item remotetimeout @var{args}
11165 @kindex remotetimeout
11166 @value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11167 This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11168 seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
11169 @end table
11170
11171 @cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11172 When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11173 information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11174 load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11175 @samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
11176
11177 @example
11178 sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11179 @end example
11180
11181 You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
11182
11183 @example
11184 sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11185 @end example
11186
11187 @cindex running, on Sparclet
11188 Once you have set
11189 your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11190 run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11191 (or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
11192
11193 @value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11194
11195 @example
11196 (gdbslet)
11197 @end example
11198
11199 @menu
11200 * Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11201 * Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11202 * Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11203 * Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
11204 @end menu
11205
11206 @node Sparclet File
11207 @subsubsection Setting file to debug
11208
11209 The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
11210
11211 @example
11212 (gdbslet) file prog
11213 @end example
11214
11215 @need 1000
11216 @value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11217 @value{GDBN} locates
11218 the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11219 path.
11220 If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11221 files will be searched as well.
11222 @value{GDBN} locates
11223 the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11224 path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11225 If it fails
11226 to find a file, it displays a message such as:
11227
11228 @example
11229 prog: No such file or directory.
11230 @end example
11231
11232 When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11233 the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11234 @code{target} command again.
11235
11236 @node Sparclet Connection
11237 @subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
11238
11239 The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11240 To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
11241
11242 @example
11243 (gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11244 Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11245 main () at ../prog.c:3
11246 @end example
11247
11248 @need 750
11249 @value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
11250
11251 @example
11252 Connected to ttya.
11253 @end example
11254
11255 @node Sparclet Download
11256 @subsubsection Sparclet download
11257
11258 @cindex download to Sparclet
11259 Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11260 you can use the @value{GDBN}
11261 @code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11262 The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11263 command.
11264 Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11265 address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11266 offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11267 of each of the file's sections.
11268 For instance, if the program
11269 @file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11270 and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
11271
11272 @example
11273 (gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11274 Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11275 @end example
11276
11277 If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11278 to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11279 to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11280
11281 @node Sparclet Execution
11282 @subsubsection Running and debugging
11283
11284 @cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11285 You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11286 commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11287 manual for the list of commands.
11288
11289 @example
11290 (gdbslet) b main
11291 Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11292 (gdbslet) run
11293 Starting program: prog
11294 Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
11295 3 char *symarg = 0;
11296 (gdbslet) step
11297 4 char *execarg = "hello!";
11298 (gdbslet)
11299 @end example
11300
11301 @node Sparclite
11302 @subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
11303
11304 @table @code
11305
11306 @kindex target sparclite
11307 @item target sparclite @var{dev}
11308 Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11309 You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11310 For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11311 remote protocol.
11312
11313 @end table
11314
11315 @node ST2000
11316 @subsection Tandem ST2000
11317
11318 @value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11319 STDBUG protocol.
11320
11321 To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11322 manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
11323
11324 @example
11325 target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11326 @end example
11327
11328 @noindent
11329 to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11330 the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11331 ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11332 connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11333 concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
11334
11335 The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11336 this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11337 would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11338 (such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11339 available on your host computer.
11340 @c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11341 @c basically hearsay.
11342
11343 @cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11344 These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11345 environment:
11346
11347 @table @code
11348 @item st2000 @var{command}
11349 @kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11350 @cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11351 @cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11352 Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11353 manual for available commands.
11354
11355 @item connect
11356 @cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11357 Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11358 you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11359 sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11360 @kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11361 @kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
11362 @end table
11363
11364 @node Z8000
11365 @subsection Zilog Z8000
11366
11367 @cindex Z8000
11368 @cindex simulator, Z8000
11369 @cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
11370
11371 When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11372 a Z8000 simulator.
11373
11374 For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11375 unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11376 segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11377 appropriate by inspecting the object code.
11378
11379 @table @code
11380 @item target sim @var{args}
11381 @kindex sim
11382 @kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11383 Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11384 options, specify them via @var{args}.
11385 @end table
11386
11387 @noindent
11388 After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11389 CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11390 @code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11391 to run your program, and so on.
11392
11393 As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11394 (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11395 additional items of information as specially named registers:
11396
11397 @table @code
11398
11399 @item cycles
11400 Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
11401
11402 @item insts
11403 Counts instructions run in the simulator.
11404
11405 @item time
11406 Execution time in 60ths of a second.
11407
11408 @end table
11409
11410 You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
11411 conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
11412 conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
11413 simulated clock ticks.
11414
11415 @node Architectures
11416 @section Architectures
11417
11418 This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
11419 all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
11420
11421 @menu
11422 * A29K::
11423 * Alpha::
11424 * MIPS::
11425 @end menu
11426
11427 @node A29K
11428 @subsection A29K
11429
11430 @table @code
11431
11432 @kindex set rstack_high_address
11433 @cindex AMD 29K register stack
11434 @cindex register stack, AMD29K
11435 @item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
11436 On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
11437 @dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
11438 extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
11439 stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
11440 memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
11441 this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
11442 the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
11443 address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
11444 hexadecimal.
11445
11446 @kindex show rstack_high_address
11447 @item show rstack_high_address
11448 Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
11449 processors.
11450
11451 @end table
11452
11453 @node Alpha
11454 @subsection Alpha
11455
11456 See the following section.
11457
11458 @node MIPS
11459 @subsection MIPS
11460
11461 @cindex stack on Alpha
11462 @cindex stack on MIPS
11463 @cindex Alpha stack
11464 @cindex MIPS stack
11465 Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
11466 sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
11467 find the beginning of a function.
11468
11469 @cindex response time, MIPS debugging
11470 To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
11471 @value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
11472 you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
11473 commands:
11474
11475 @table @code
11476 @cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
11477 @item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
11478 Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
11479 search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
11480 default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
11481 larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
11482 and therefore the longer it takes to run.
11483
11484 @item show heuristic-fence-post
11485 Display the current limit.
11486 @end table
11487
11488 @noindent
11489 These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
11490 for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
11491
11492
11493 @node Controlling GDB
11494 @chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
11495
11496 You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
11497 @code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
11498 data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
11499 described here.
11500
11501 @menu
11502 * Prompt:: Prompt
11503 * Editing:: Command editing
11504 * History:: Command history
11505 * Screen Size:: Screen size
11506 * Numbers:: Numbers
11507 * Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
11508 * Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
11509 @end menu
11510
11511 @node Prompt
11512 @section Prompt
11513
11514 @cindex prompt
11515
11516 @value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
11517 called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
11518 can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
11519 instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
11520 the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
11521 which one you are talking to.
11522
11523 @emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
11524 prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
11525 or a prompt that does not.
11526
11527 @table @code
11528 @kindex set prompt
11529 @item set prompt @var{newprompt}
11530 Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
11531
11532 @kindex show prompt
11533 @item show prompt
11534 Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
11535 @end table
11536
11537 @node Editing
11538 @section Command editing
11539 @cindex readline
11540 @cindex command line editing
11541
11542 @value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
11543 @sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
11544 command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
11545 or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
11546 substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
11547 debugging sessions.
11548
11549 You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
11550 command @code{set}.
11551
11552 @table @code
11553 @kindex set editing
11554 @cindex editing
11555 @item set editing
11556 @itemx set editing on
11557 Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
11558
11559 @item set editing off
11560 Disable command line editing.
11561
11562 @kindex show editing
11563 @item show editing
11564 Show whether command line editing is enabled.
11565 @end table
11566
11567 @node History
11568 @section Command history
11569
11570 @value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
11571 debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
11572 happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
11573 history facility.
11574
11575 @table @code
11576 @cindex history substitution
11577 @cindex history file
11578 @kindex set history filename
11579 @kindex GDBHISTFILE
11580 @item set history filename @var{fname}
11581 Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
11582 This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
11583 list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
11584 exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
11585 the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
11586 to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
11587 @file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
11588 is not set.
11589
11590 @cindex history save
11591 @kindex set history save
11592 @item set history save
11593 @itemx set history save on
11594 Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
11595 @code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
11596
11597 @item set history save off
11598 Stop recording command history in a file.
11599
11600 @cindex history size
11601 @kindex set history size
11602 @item set history size @var{size}
11603 Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
11604 This defaults to the value of the environment variable
11605 @code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
11606 @end table
11607
11608 @cindex history expansion
11609 History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
11610 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11611 @xref{Event Designators}.
11612 @end ifset
11613
11614 Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
11615 is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
11616 @code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
11617 follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
11618 a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
11619 history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
11620 @kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
11621
11622 The commands to control history expansion are:
11623
11624 @table @code
11625 @kindex set history expansion
11626 @item set history expansion on
11627 @itemx set history expansion
11628 Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
11629
11630 @item set history expansion off
11631 Disable history expansion.
11632
11633 The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
11634 editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
11635 or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
11636 @ifset have-readline-appendices
11637 @xref{Command Line Editing}.
11638 @end ifset
11639
11640 @c @group
11641 @kindex show history
11642 @item show history
11643 @itemx show history filename
11644 @itemx show history save
11645 @itemx show history size
11646 @itemx show history expansion
11647 These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
11648 @code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
11649 @c @end group
11650 @end table
11651
11652 @table @code
11653 @kindex shows
11654 @item show commands
11655 Display the last ten commands in the command history.
11656
11657 @item show commands @var{n}
11658 Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
11659
11660 @item show commands +
11661 Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
11662 @end table
11663
11664 @node Screen Size
11665 @section Screen size
11666 @cindex size of screen
11667 @cindex pauses in output
11668
11669 Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
11670 information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
11671 @value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
11672 output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
11673 to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
11674 determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
11675 printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
11676 rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
11677
11678 Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
11679 driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
11680 together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
11681 @code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
11682 you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
11683 width} commands:
11684
11685 @table @code
11686 @kindex set height
11687 @kindex set width
11688 @kindex show width
11689 @kindex show height
11690 @item set height @var{lpp}
11691 @itemx show height
11692 @itemx set width @var{cpl}
11693 @itemx show width
11694 These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
11695 a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
11696 commands display the current settings.
11697
11698 If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
11699 output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
11700 file or to an editor buffer.
11701
11702 Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
11703 from wrapping its output.
11704 @end table
11705
11706 @node Numbers
11707 @section Numbers
11708 @cindex number representation
11709 @cindex entering numbers
11710
11711 You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
11712 @value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
11713 @samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
11714 begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
11715 default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
11716 numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
11717 change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
11718 radix} command.
11719
11720 @table @code
11721 @kindex set input-radix
11722 @item set input-radix @var{base}
11723 Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
11724 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11725 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
11726 example, any of
11727
11728 @smallexample
11729 set radix 012
11730 set radix 10.
11731 set radix 0xa
11732 @end smallexample
11733
11734 @noindent
11735 sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
11736 leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
11737
11738 @kindex set output-radix
11739 @item set output-radix @var{base}
11740 Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
11741 for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
11742 specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
11743
11744 @kindex show input-radix
11745 @item show input-radix
11746 Display the current default base for numeric input.
11747
11748 @kindex show output-radix
11749 @item show output-radix
11750 Display the current default base for numeric display.
11751 @end table
11752
11753 @node Messages/Warnings
11754 @section Optional warnings and messages
11755
11756 By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
11757 running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
11758 command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
11759 internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
11760
11761 Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
11762 which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
11763 see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
11764
11765 @table @code
11766 @kindex set verbose
11767 @item set verbose on
11768 Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11769
11770 @item set verbose off
11771 Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
11772
11773 @kindex show verbose
11774 @item show verbose
11775 Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
11776 @end table
11777
11778 By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
11779 object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
11780 find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
11781 symbol files}).
11782
11783 @table @code
11784
11785 @kindex set complaints
11786 @item set complaints @var{limit}
11787 Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
11788 unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
11789 @var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
11790 to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
11791
11792 @kindex show complaints
11793 @item show complaints
11794 Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
11795
11796 @end table
11797
11798 By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
11799 lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
11800 you try to run a program which is already running:
11801
11802 @example
11803 (@value{GDBP}) run
11804 The program being debugged has been started already.
11805 Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
11806 @end example
11807
11808 If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
11809 commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
11810
11811 @table @code
11812
11813 @kindex set confirm
11814 @cindex flinching
11815 @cindex confirmation
11816 @cindex stupid questions
11817 @item set confirm off
11818 Disables confirmation requests.
11819
11820 @item set confirm on
11821 Enables confirmation requests (the default).
11822
11823 @kindex show confirm
11824 @item show confirm
11825 Displays state of confirmation requests.
11826
11827 @end table
11828
11829 @node Debugging Output
11830 @section Optional messages about internal happenings
11831 @table @code
11832 @kindex set debug arch
11833 @item set debug arch
11834 Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
11835 @kindex show debug arch
11836 @item show debug arch
11837 Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
11838 @kindex set debug event
11839 @item set debug event
11840 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
11841 default is off.
11842 @kindex show debug event
11843 @item show debug event
11844 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
11845 info.
11846 @kindex set debug expression
11847 @item set debug expression
11848 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
11849 default is off.
11850 @kindex show debug expression
11851 @item show debug expression
11852 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
11853 debugging info.
11854 @kindex set debug overload
11855 @item set debug overload
11856 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C++ overload debugging
11857 info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
11858 is off.
11859 @kindex show debug overload
11860 @item show debug overload
11861 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C++ overload
11862 debugging info.
11863 @kindex set debug remote
11864 @cindex packets, reporting on stdout
11865 @cindex serial connections, debugging
11866 @item set debug remote
11867 Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
11868 the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
11869 @value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
11870 @kindex show debug remote
11871 @item show debug remote
11872 Displays the state of display of remote packets.
11873 @kindex set debug serial
11874 @item set debug serial
11875 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
11876 default is off.
11877 @kindex show debug serial
11878 @item show debug serial
11879 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
11880 info.
11881 @kindex set debug target
11882 @item set debug target
11883 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
11884 includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
11885 default is off.
11886 @kindex show debug target
11887 @item show debug target
11888 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
11889 info.
11890 @kindex set debug varobj
11891 @item set debug varobj
11892 Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
11893 info. The default is off.
11894 @kindex show debug varobj
11895 @item show debug varobj
11896 Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
11897 debugging info.
11898 @end table
11899
11900 @node Sequences
11901 @chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
11902
11903 Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
11904 command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
11905 commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
11906 files.
11907
11908 @menu
11909 * Define:: User-defined commands
11910 * Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
11911 * Command Files:: Command files
11912 * Output:: Commands for controlled output
11913 @end menu
11914
11915 @node Define
11916 @section User-defined commands
11917
11918 @cindex user-defined command
11919 A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
11920 which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
11921 @code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
11922 separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
11923 via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
11924
11925 @smallexample
11926 define adder
11927 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
11928 @end smallexample
11929
11930 @noindent
11931 To execute the command use:
11932
11933 @smallexample
11934 adder 1 2 3
11935 @end smallexample
11936
11937 @noindent
11938 This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
11939 its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
11940 reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
11941 functions calls.
11942
11943 @table @code
11944
11945 @kindex define
11946 @item define @var{commandname}
11947 Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
11948 by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
11949
11950 The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
11951 which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
11952 commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11953
11954 @kindex if
11955 @kindex else
11956 @item if
11957 Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
11958 It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
11959 only if the expression is true (nonzero).
11960 There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
11961 by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
11962 was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
11963
11964 @kindex while
11965 @item while
11966 The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
11967 which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
11968 execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
11969 The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
11970 evaluates to true.
11971
11972 @kindex document
11973 @item document @var{commandname}
11974 Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
11975 accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
11976 defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
11977 reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
11978 After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
11979 @var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
11980
11981 You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
11982 documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
11983 does not change the documentation.
11984
11985 @kindex help user-defined
11986 @item help user-defined
11987 List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
11988 (if any) for each.
11989
11990 @kindex show user
11991 @item show user
11992 @itemx show user @var{commandname}
11993 Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
11994 not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
11995 definitions for all user-defined commands.
11996
11997 @end table
11998
11999 When user-defined commands are executed, the
12000 commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12001 stops execution of the user-defined command.
12002
12003 If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12004 without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12005 commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12006 messages when used in a user-defined command.
12007
12008 @node Hooks
12009 @section User-defined command hooks
12010 @cindex command hooks
12011 @cindex hooks, for commands
12012 @cindex hooks, pre-command
12013
12014 @kindex hook
12015 @kindex hook-
12016 You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12017 command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12018 command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12019 before that command.
12020
12021 @cindex hooks, post-command
12022 @kindex hookpost
12023 @kindex hookpost-
12024 A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12025 Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12026 @samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12027 that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12028 pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
12029
12030 It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12031 occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
12032
12033 @c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12034 @c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
12035
12036 @kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12037 In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12038 (@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12039 execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12040 displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
12041
12042 For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12043 single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12044 you could define:
12045
12046 @example
12047 define hook-stop
12048 handle SIGALRM nopass
12049 end
12050
12051 define hook-run
12052 handle SIGALRM pass
12053 end
12054
12055 define hook-continue
12056 handle SIGLARM pass
12057 end
12058 @end example
12059
12060 As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12061 command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12062 you could define:
12063
12064 @example
12065 define hook-echo
12066 echo <<<---
12067 end
12068
12069 define hookpost-echo
12070 echo --->>>\n
12071 end
12072
12073 (@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12074 <<<---Hello World--->>>
12075 (@value{GDBP})
12076
12077 @end example
12078
12079 You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12080 not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12081 name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12082 @c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12083 @c or not?
12084 If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12085 @value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12086 (before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
12087
12088 If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12089 get a warning from the @code{define} command.
12090
12091 @node Command Files
12092 @section Command files
12093
12094 @cindex command files
12095 A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12096 commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12097 An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12098 the last command, as it would from the terminal.
12099
12100 @cindex init file
12101 @cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12102 @cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12103 When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12104 @dfn{init files}. These are files named @file{.gdbinit} on Unix and
12105 @file{gdb.ini} on DOS/Windows. During startup, @value{GDBN} does the
12106 following:
12107
12108 @enumerate
12109 @item
12110 Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12111 DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12112 @code{HOME} environment variable.}.
12113
12114 @item
12115 Processes command line options and operands.
12116
12117 @item
12118 Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
12119
12120 @item
12121 Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12122 @end enumerate
12123
12124 The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12125 complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12126 and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12127 option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
12128
12129 @cindex init file name
12130 On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12131 different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12132 form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12133 different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12134 environments with special init file names:
12135
12136 @cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12137 @itemize @bullet
12138 @item
12139 VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
12140
12141 @cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12142 @item
12143 OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
12144
12145 @cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12146 @item
12147 ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12148 @end itemize
12149
12150 You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12151 @code{source} command:
12152
12153 @table @code
12154 @kindex source
12155 @item source @var{filename}
12156 Execute the command file @var{filename}.
12157 @end table
12158
12159 The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12160 printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12161 of the command file.
12162
12163 Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12164 without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12165 normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12166 when called from command files.
12167
12168 @node Output
12169 @section Commands for controlled output
12170
12171 During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12172 @value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12173 explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12174 describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12175 want.
12176
12177 @table @code
12178 @kindex echo
12179 @item echo @var{text}
12180 @c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12181 @c because it is not in ANSI.
12182 Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12183 @var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12184 newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12185 In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12186 by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12187 string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12188 trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12189 To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12190 @samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
12191
12192 A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12193 the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
12194
12195 @example
12196 echo This is some text\n\
12197 which is continued\n\
12198 onto several lines.\n
12199 @end example
12200
12201 produces the same output as
12202
12203 @example
12204 echo This is some text\n
12205 echo which is continued\n
12206 echo onto several lines.\n
12207 @end example
12208
12209 @kindex output
12210 @item output @var{expression}
12211 Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12212 newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12213 value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12214 on expressions.
12215
12216 @item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12217 Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12218 the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12219 formats}, for more information.
12220
12221 @kindex printf
12222 @item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12223 Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12224 @var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12225 either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12226 @var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12227 subroutine
12228 @c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12229 @c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12230 @c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12231 @c supported.
12232
12233 @example
12234 printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12235 @end example
12236
12237 For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
12238
12239 @smallexample
12240 printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12241 @end smallexample
12242
12243 The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12244 string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12245 letter.
12246 @end table
12247
12248 @node Emacs
12249 @chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
12250
12251 @cindex Emacs
12252 @cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
12253 A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
12254 edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
12255 @value{GDBN}.
12256
12257 To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
12258 executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
12259 @value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
12260 created Emacs buffer.
12261 @c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
12262
12263 Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
12264 things:
12265
12266 @itemize @bullet
12267 @item
12268 All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
12269 @end itemize
12270
12271 This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
12272 and output done by the program you are debugging.
12273
12274 This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
12275 commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
12276 in this way.
12277
12278 All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
12279 with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
12280 way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
12281 stop.
12282
12283 @itemize @bullet
12284 @item
12285 @value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
12286 @end itemize
12287
12288 Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
12289 source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
12290 left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
12291 source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
12292 and the source.
12293
12294 Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
12295 usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
12296
12297 @quotation
12298 @emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
12299 current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
12300 the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
12301 appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
12302 environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
12303 session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
12304 back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
12305 avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
12306 your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
12307 @kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
12308
12309 A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
12310 switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
12311 @value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
12312 @end quotation
12313
12314 By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
12315 you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
12316 several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
12317 Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
12318
12319 @example
12320 (setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
12321 @end example
12322
12323 @noindent
12324 (preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
12325 in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
12326 ``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
12327
12328 In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
12329 addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
12330
12331 @table @kbd
12332 @item C-h m
12333 Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
12334
12335 @item M-s
12336 Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
12337 update the display window to show the current file and location.
12338
12339 @item M-n
12340 Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
12341 calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
12342 to show the current file and location.
12343
12344 @item M-i
12345 Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
12346 display window accordingly.
12347
12348 @item M-x gdb-nexti
12349 Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
12350 display window accordingly.
12351
12352 @item C-c C-f
12353 Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
12354 @code{finish} command.
12355
12356 @item M-c
12357 Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
12358 command.
12359
12360 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
12361
12362 @item M-u
12363 Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
12364 (@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
12365 like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
12366
12367 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
12368
12369 @item M-d
12370 Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
12371 @value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
12372
12373 @emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
12374
12375 @item C-x &
12376 Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
12377 of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
12378 around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
12379 then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
12380 argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
12381
12382 You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
12383 @code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
12384 otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
12385 inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
12386 wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
12387 list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
12388 formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
12389 is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
12390 @end table
12391
12392 In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
12393 tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
12394
12395 If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
12396 it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
12397 request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
12398 the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
12399 frame.
12400
12401 The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
12402 which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
12403 the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
12404 communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
12405 delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
12406 to correspond properly with the code.
12407
12408 @c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
12409 @c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
12410 @ignore
12411 @kindex Emacs Epoch environment
12412 @kindex Epoch
12413 @kindex inspect
12414
12415 Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
12416 called the @code{epoch}
12417 environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
12418 @code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
12419 each value is printed in its own window.
12420 @end ignore
12421
12422 @include annotate.texi
12423 @include gdbmi.texinfo
12424
12425 @node GDB Bugs
12426 @chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
12427 @cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
12428 @cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
12429
12430 Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
12431
12432 Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
12433 may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
12434 the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
12435 reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
12436
12437 In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
12438 information that enables us to fix the bug.
12439
12440 @menu
12441 * Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
12442 * Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
12443 @end menu
12444
12445 @node Bug Criteria
12446 @section Have you found a bug?
12447 @cindex bug criteria
12448
12449 If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
12450
12451 @itemize @bullet
12452 @cindex fatal signal
12453 @cindex debugger crash
12454 @cindex crash of debugger
12455 @item
12456 If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
12457 @value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
12458
12459 @cindex error on valid input
12460 @item
12461 If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
12462 bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
12463 somewhere in the connection to the target.)
12464
12465 @cindex invalid input
12466 @item
12467 If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
12468 that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
12469 ``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
12470 for traditional practice''.
12471
12472 @item
12473 If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
12474 for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
12475 @end itemize
12476
12477 @node Bug Reporting
12478 @section How to report bugs
12479 @cindex bug reports
12480 @cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
12481
12482 A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
12483 If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
12484 contact that organization first.
12485
12486 You can find contact information for many support companies and
12487 individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
12488 distribution.
12489 @c should add a web page ref...
12490
12491 In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
12492 @value{GDBN} to this addresses:
12493
12494 @example
12495 bug-gdb@@gnu.org
12496 @end example
12497
12498 @strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
12499 @samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
12500 not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
12501 @samp{bug-gdb}.
12502
12503 The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
12504 serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
12505 the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
12506 newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
12507 problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
12508 path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
12509 we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
12510 bug reports to the mailing list.
12511
12512 As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
12513
12514 @example
12515 @sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
12516 Free Software Foundation Inc.
12517 59 Temple Place - Suite 330
12518 Boston, MA 02111-1307
12519 USA
12520 @end example
12521
12522 The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
12523 @strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
12524 fact or leave it out, state it!
12525
12526 Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
12527 problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
12528 assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
12529 Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
12530 stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
12531 name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
12532 of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
12533 the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
12534 easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
12535
12536 Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
12537 bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
12538 you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
12539 self-contained.
12540
12541 Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
12542 bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
12543 @emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
12544 bugs properly.
12545
12546 To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
12547
12548 @itemize @bullet
12549 @item
12550 The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
12551 with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
12552 version}.
12553
12554 Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
12555 the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
12556
12557 @item
12558 The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
12559 version number.
12560
12561 @item
12562 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
12563 ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
12564
12565 @item
12566 What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
12567 debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
12568 C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
12569 information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
12570 compilers.
12571
12572 @item
12573 The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
12574 observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
12575 you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
12576 Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
12577
12578 If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
12579 and then we might not encounter the bug.
12580
12581 @item
12582 A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
12583 reproduce the bug.
12584
12585 @item
12586 A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
12587 incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
12588
12589 Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
12590 will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
12591 not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
12592 a chance to make a mistake.
12593
12594 Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
12595 say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
12596 copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
12597 the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
12598 crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
12599 ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
12600 us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
12601 to draw any conclusion from our observations.
12602
12603 @item
12604 If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
12605 diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
12606 it by context, not by line number.
12607
12608 The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
12609 sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
12610
12611 @end itemize
12612
12613 Here are some things that are not necessary:
12614
12615 @itemize @bullet
12616 @item
12617 A description of the envelope of the bug.
12618
12619 Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
12620 which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
12621 changes will not affect it.
12622
12623 This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
12624 will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
12625 with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
12626 We recommend that you save your time for something else.
12627
12628 Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
12629 of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
12630 output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
12631 less time, and so on.
12632
12633 However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
12634 report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
12635
12636 @item
12637 A patch for the bug.
12638
12639 A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
12640 the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
12641 a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
12642 to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
12643
12644 Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
12645 construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
12646 through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
12647 to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
12648
12649 And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
12650 patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
12651 help us to understand.
12652
12653 @item
12654 A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
12655
12656 Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
12657 things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
12658 @end itemize
12659
12660 @c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
12661 @c and consists of the two following files:
12662 @c rluser.texinfo
12663 @c inc-hist.texinfo
12664 @c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
12665 @c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
12666 @include rluser.texinfo
12667 @include inc-hist.texinfo
12668
12669
12670 @node Formatting Documentation
12671 @appendix Formatting Documentation
12672
12673 @cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
12674 @cindex reference card
12675 The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
12676 for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
12677 subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
12678 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
12679 release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
12680 you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
12681
12682 The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
12683 can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
12684
12685 @example
12686 make refcard.dvi
12687 @end example
12688
12689 The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
12690 mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
12691 that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
12692 high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
12693 your @sc{dvi} output program.
12694
12695 @cindex documentation
12696
12697 All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
12698 distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
12699 a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
12700 on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
12701 formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
12702 and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
12703
12704 @value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
12705 version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
12706 file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
12707 subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
12708 necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
12709 but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
12710 Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
12711 @sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
12712
12713 If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
12714 Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
12715 @code{makeinfo}.
12716
12717 If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
12718 @value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
12719 version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
12720
12721 @example
12722 cd gdb
12723 make gdb.info
12724 @end example
12725
12726 If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
12727 a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
12728 Texinfo definitions file.
12729
12730 @TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
12731 produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
12732 document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
12733 has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
12734 command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
12735 (for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
12736 require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
12737
12738 @TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
12739 @file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
12740 written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
12741 typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
12742 and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
12743 directory.
12744
12745 If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
12746 typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
12747 subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
12748 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
12749
12750 @example
12751 make gdb.dvi
12752 @end example
12753
12754 Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
12755
12756 @node Installing GDB
12757 @appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
12758 @cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
12759 @cindex installation
12760
12761 @value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
12762 of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
12763 build the @code{gdb} program.
12764 @iftex
12765 @c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
12766 @footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
12767 look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
12768 installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
12769 @end iftex
12770
12771 The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
12772 @value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
12773 appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
12774
12775 For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
12776 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
12777
12778 @table @code
12779 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
12780 script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
12781
12782 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
12783 the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
12784
12785 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12786 source for the Binary File Descriptor library
12787
12788 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
12789 @sc{gnu} include files
12790
12791 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
12792 source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
12793
12794 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
12795 source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
12796
12797 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
12798 source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
12799
12800 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
12801 source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
12802
12803 @item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
12804 source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
12805 @end table
12806
12807 The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
12808 from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
12809 this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
12810
12811 First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
12812 if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
12813 identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
12814 argument.
12815
12816 For example:
12817
12818 @example
12819 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12820 ./configure @var{host}
12821 make
12822 @end example
12823
12824 @noindent
12825 where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
12826 @samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
12827 (You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
12828 correct value by examining your system.)
12829
12830 Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
12831 @file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
12832 libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
12833 binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
12834
12835 @need 750
12836 @code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
12837 system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
12838 shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
12839
12840 @example
12841 sh configure @var{host}
12842 @end example
12843
12844 If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
12845 directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
12846 @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
12847 creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
12848 you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
12849
12850 You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
12851 subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
12852 configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
12853
12854 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
12855 the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
12856
12857 @example
12858 @group
12859 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
12860 ../configure @var{host}
12861 @end group
12862 @end example
12863
12864 You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
12865 However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
12866 the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
12867 that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
12868 let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
12869
12870 @menu
12871 * Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12872 * Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
12873 * Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
12874 @end menu
12875
12876 @node Separate Objdir
12877 @section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
12878
12879 If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
12880 you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
12881 host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
12882 allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
12883 rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
12884 handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
12885 @code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
12886 program specified there.
12887
12888 To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
12889 with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
12890 (You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
12891 itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
12892 would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
12893 the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
12894
12895 For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
12896 separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
12897
12898 @example
12899 @group
12900 cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
12901 mkdir ../gdb-sun4
12902 cd ../gdb-sun4
12903 ../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
12904 make
12905 @end group
12906 @end example
12907
12908 When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
12909 directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
12910 (and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
12911 the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
12912 directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
12913 @file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
12914
12915 One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
12916 directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
12917 @value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
12918 programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
12919 You specify a cross-debugging target by
12920 giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
12921
12922 When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
12923 it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
12924 called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
12925
12926 The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
12927 directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
12928 directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
12929 directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
12930 will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
12931
12932 When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
12933 directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
12934 if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
12935 with each other.
12936
12937 @node Config Names
12938 @section Specifying names for hosts and targets
12939
12940 The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
12941 script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
12942 aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
12943 of information in the following pattern:
12944
12945 @example
12946 @var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
12947 @end example
12948
12949 For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
12950 or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
12951 option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
12952
12953 The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
12954 any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
12955 aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
12956 @code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
12957 script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
12958 abbreviations---for example:
12959
12960 @smallexample
12961 % sh config.sub i386-linux
12962 i386-pc-linux-gnu
12963 % sh config.sub alpha-linux
12964 alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
12965 % sh config.sub hp9k700
12966 hppa1.1-hp-hpux
12967 % sh config.sub sun4
12968 sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
12969 % sh config.sub sun3
12970 m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
12971 % sh config.sub i986v
12972 Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
12973 @end smallexample
12974
12975 @noindent
12976 @code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
12977 directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
12978
12979 @node Configure Options
12980 @section @code{configure} options
12981
12982 Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
12983 are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
12984 several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
12985 Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
12986
12987 @example
12988 configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
12989 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12990 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
12991 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
12992 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
12993 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
12994 @var{host}
12995 @end example
12996
12997 @noindent
12998 You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
12999 @samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13000 @samp{--}.
13001
13002 @table @code
13003 @item --help
13004 Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
13005
13006 @item --prefix=@var{dir}
13007 Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13008 @file{@var{dir}}.
13009
13010 @item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13011 Configure the source to install programs under directory
13012 @file{@var{dir}}.
13013
13014 @c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13015 @need 2000
13016 @item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13017 @strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13018 @code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13019 Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13020 @value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13021 build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13022 directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13023 the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13024 directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13025 the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13026 @var{dirname}.
13027
13028 @item --norecursion
13029 Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13030 propagate configuration to subdirectories.
13031
13032 @item --target=@var{target}
13033 Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13034 @var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13035 programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
13036
13037 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
13038
13039 @item @var{host} @dots{}
13040 Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
13041
13042 There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13043 @end table
13044
13045 There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13046 needed for special purposes only.
13047
13048 @node Index
13049 @unnumbered Index
13050
13051 @printindex cp
13052
13053 @tex
13054 % I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
13055 % meantime:
13056 \long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
13057 \centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
13058 \centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
13059 \centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
13060 \centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
13061 \centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
13062 \centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
13063 \centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
13064 \centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
13065 \page\colophon
13066 % Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
13067 @end tex
13068
13069 @c TeX can handle the contents at the start but makeinfo 3.12 can not
13070 @ifinfo
13071 @contents
13072 @end ifinfo
13073 @ifhtml
13074 @contents
13075 @end ifhtml
13076
13077 @bye
This page took 0.415519 seconds and 5 git commands to generate.